1 //===---- TargetInfo.cpp - Encapsulate target details -----------*- C++ -*-===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // These classes wrap the information about a call or function 11 // definition used to handle ABI compliancy. 12 // 13 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 14 15 #include "TargetInfo.h" 16 #include "ABIInfo.h" 17 #include "CGCXXABI.h" 18 #include "CGValue.h" 19 #include "CodeGenFunction.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h" 21 #include "clang/CodeGen/CGFunctionInfo.h" 22 #include "clang/CodeGen/SwiftCallingConv.h" 23 #include "clang/Frontend/CodeGenOptions.h" 24 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h" 25 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 26 #include "llvm/IR/DataLayout.h" 27 #include "llvm/IR/Type.h" 28 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h" 29 #include <algorithm> // std::sort 30 31 using namespace clang; 32 using namespace CodeGen; 33 34 // Helper for coercing an aggregate argument or return value into an integer 35 // array of the same size (including padding) and alignment. This alternate 36 // coercion happens only for the RenderScript ABI and can be removed after 37 // runtimes that rely on it are no longer supported. 38 // 39 // RenderScript assumes that the size of the argument / return value in the IR 40 // is the same as the size of the corresponding qualified type. This helper 41 // coerces the aggregate type into an array of the same size (including 42 // padding). This coercion is used in lieu of expansion of struct members or 43 // other canonical coercions that return a coerced-type of larger size. 44 // 45 // Ty - The argument / return value type 46 // Context - The associated ASTContext 47 // LLVMContext - The associated LLVMContext 48 static ABIArgInfo coerceToIntArray(QualType Ty, 49 ASTContext &Context, 50 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext) { 51 // Alignment and Size are measured in bits. 52 const uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 53 const uint64_t Alignment = Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 54 llvm::Type *IntType = llvm::Type::getIntNTy(LLVMContext, Alignment); 55 const uint64_t NumElements = (Size + Alignment - 1) / Alignment; 56 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(IntType, NumElements)); 57 } 58 59 static void AssignToArrayRange(CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder, 60 llvm::Value *Array, 61 llvm::Value *Value, 62 unsigned FirstIndex, 63 unsigned LastIndex) { 64 // Alternatively, we could emit this as a loop in the source. 65 for (unsigned I = FirstIndex; I <= LastIndex; ++I) { 66 llvm::Value *Cell = 67 Builder.CreateConstInBoundsGEP1_32(Builder.getInt8Ty(), Array, I); 68 Builder.CreateAlignedStore(Value, Cell, CharUnits::One()); 69 } 70 } 71 72 static bool isAggregateTypeForABI(QualType T) { 73 return !CodeGenFunction::hasScalarEvaluationKind(T) || 74 T->isMemberFunctionPointerType(); 75 } 76 77 ABIArgInfo 78 ABIInfo::getNaturalAlignIndirect(QualType Ty, bool ByRef, bool Realign, 79 llvm::Type *Padding) const { 80 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty), 81 ByRef, Realign, Padding); 82 } 83 84 ABIArgInfo 85 ABIInfo::getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(QualType Ty, bool Realign) const { 86 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirectInReg(getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty), 87 /*ByRef*/ false, Realign); 88 } 89 90 Address ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 91 QualType Ty) const { 92 return Address::invalid(); 93 } 94 95 ABIInfo::~ABIInfo() {} 96 97 /// Does the given lowering require more than the given number of 98 /// registers when expanded? 99 /// 100 /// This is intended to be the basis of a reasonable basic implementation 101 /// of should{Pass,Return}IndirectlyForSwift. 102 /// 103 /// For most targets, a limit of four total registers is reasonable; this 104 /// limits the amount of code required in order to move around the value 105 /// in case it wasn't produced immediately prior to the call by the caller 106 /// (or wasn't produced in exactly the right registers) or isn't used 107 /// immediately within the callee. But some targets may need to further 108 /// limit the register count due to an inability to support that many 109 /// return registers. 110 static bool occupiesMoreThan(CodeGenTypes &cgt, 111 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalarTypes, 112 unsigned maxAllRegisters) { 113 unsigned intCount = 0, fpCount = 0; 114 for (llvm::Type *type : scalarTypes) { 115 if (type->isPointerTy()) { 116 intCount++; 117 } else if (auto intTy = dyn_cast<llvm::IntegerType>(type)) { 118 auto ptrWidth = cgt.getTarget().getPointerWidth(0); 119 intCount += (intTy->getBitWidth() + ptrWidth - 1) / ptrWidth; 120 } else { 121 assert(type->isVectorTy() || type->isFloatingPointTy()); 122 fpCount++; 123 } 124 } 125 126 return (intCount + fpCount > maxAllRegisters); 127 } 128 129 bool SwiftABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits vectorSize, 130 llvm::Type *eltTy, 131 unsigned numElts) const { 132 // The default implementation of this assumes that the target guarantees 133 // 128-bit SIMD support but nothing more. 134 return (vectorSize.getQuantity() > 8 && vectorSize.getQuantity() <= 16); 135 } 136 137 static CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI getRecordArgABI(const RecordType *RT, 138 CGCXXABI &CXXABI) { 139 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 140 if (!RD) 141 return CGCXXABI::RAA_Default; 142 return CXXABI.getRecordArgABI(RD); 143 } 144 145 static CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI getRecordArgABI(QualType T, 146 CGCXXABI &CXXABI) { 147 const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 148 if (!RT) 149 return CGCXXABI::RAA_Default; 150 return getRecordArgABI(RT, CXXABI); 151 } 152 153 /// Pass transparent unions as if they were the type of the first element. Sema 154 /// should ensure that all elements of the union have the same "machine type". 155 static QualType useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(QualType Ty) { 156 if (const RecordType *UT = Ty->getAsUnionType()) { 157 const RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 158 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) { 159 assert(!UD->field_empty() && "sema created an empty transparent union"); 160 return UD->field_begin()->getType(); 161 } 162 } 163 return Ty; 164 } 165 166 CGCXXABI &ABIInfo::getCXXABI() const { 167 return CGT.getCXXABI(); 168 } 169 170 ASTContext &ABIInfo::getContext() const { 171 return CGT.getContext(); 172 } 173 174 llvm::LLVMContext &ABIInfo::getVMContext() const { 175 return CGT.getLLVMContext(); 176 } 177 178 const llvm::DataLayout &ABIInfo::getDataLayout() const { 179 return CGT.getDataLayout(); 180 } 181 182 const TargetInfo &ABIInfo::getTarget() const { 183 return CGT.getTarget(); 184 } 185 186 bool ABIInfo:: isAndroid() const { return getTarget().getTriple().isAndroid(); } 187 188 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 189 return false; 190 } 191 192 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base, 193 uint64_t Members) const { 194 return false; 195 } 196 197 bool ABIInfo::shouldSignExtUnsignedType(QualType Ty) const { 198 return false; 199 } 200 201 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void ABIArgInfo::dump() const { 202 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 203 OS << "(ABIArgInfo Kind="; 204 switch (TheKind) { 205 case Direct: 206 OS << "Direct Type="; 207 if (llvm::Type *Ty = getCoerceToType()) 208 Ty->print(OS); 209 else 210 OS << "null"; 211 break; 212 case Extend: 213 OS << "Extend"; 214 break; 215 case Ignore: 216 OS << "Ignore"; 217 break; 218 case InAlloca: 219 OS << "InAlloca Offset=" << getInAllocaFieldIndex(); 220 break; 221 case Indirect: 222 OS << "Indirect Align=" << getIndirectAlign().getQuantity() 223 << " ByVal=" << getIndirectByVal() 224 << " Realign=" << getIndirectRealign(); 225 break; 226 case Expand: 227 OS << "Expand"; 228 break; 229 case CoerceAndExpand: 230 OS << "CoerceAndExpand Type="; 231 getCoerceAndExpandType()->print(OS); 232 break; 233 } 234 OS << ")\n"; 235 } 236 237 // Dynamically round a pointer up to a multiple of the given alignment. 238 static llvm::Value *emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 239 llvm::Value *Ptr, 240 CharUnits Align) { 241 llvm::Value *PtrAsInt = Ptr; 242 // OverflowArgArea = (OverflowArgArea + Align - 1) & -Align; 243 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(PtrAsInt, CGF.IntPtrTy); 244 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(PtrAsInt, 245 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.IntPtrTy, Align.getQuantity() - 1)); 246 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(PtrAsInt, 247 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.IntPtrTy, -Align.getQuantity())); 248 PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(PtrAsInt, 249 Ptr->getType(), 250 Ptr->getName() + ".aligned"); 251 return PtrAsInt; 252 } 253 254 /// Emit va_arg for a platform using the common void* representation, 255 /// where arguments are simply emitted in an array of slots on the stack. 256 /// 257 /// This version implements the core direct-value passing rules. 258 /// 259 /// \param SlotSize - The size and alignment of a stack slot. 260 /// Each argument will be allocated to a multiple of this number of 261 /// slots, and all the slots will be aligned to this value. 262 /// \param AllowHigherAlign - The slot alignment is not a cap; 263 /// an argument type with an alignment greater than the slot size 264 /// will be emitted on a higher-alignment address, potentially 265 /// leaving one or more empty slots behind as padding. If this 266 /// is false, the returned address might be less-aligned than 267 /// DirectAlign. 268 static Address emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 269 Address VAListAddr, 270 llvm::Type *DirectTy, 271 CharUnits DirectSize, 272 CharUnits DirectAlign, 273 CharUnits SlotSize, 274 bool AllowHigherAlign) { 275 // Cast the element type to i8* if necessary. Some platforms define 276 // va_list as a struct containing an i8* instead of just an i8*. 277 if (VAListAddr.getElementType() != CGF.Int8PtrTy) 278 VAListAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(VAListAddr, CGF.Int8PtrTy); 279 280 llvm::Value *Ptr = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "argp.cur"); 281 282 // If the CC aligns values higher than the slot size, do so if needed. 283 Address Addr = Address::invalid(); 284 if (AllowHigherAlign && DirectAlign > SlotSize) { 285 Addr = Address(emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, Ptr, DirectAlign), 286 DirectAlign); 287 } else { 288 Addr = Address(Ptr, SlotSize); 289 } 290 291 // Advance the pointer past the argument, then store that back. 292 CharUnits FullDirectSize = DirectSize.alignTo(SlotSize); 293 llvm::Value *NextPtr = 294 CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr.getPointer(), FullDirectSize, 295 "argp.next"); 296 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NextPtr, VAListAddr); 297 298 // If the argument is smaller than a slot, and this is a big-endian 299 // target, the argument will be right-adjusted in its slot. 300 if (DirectSize < SlotSize && CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && 301 !DirectTy->isStructTy()) { 302 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, SlotSize - DirectSize); 303 } 304 305 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, DirectTy); 306 return Addr; 307 } 308 309 /// Emit va_arg for a platform using the common void* representation, 310 /// where arguments are simply emitted in an array of slots on the stack. 311 /// 312 /// \param IsIndirect - Values of this type are passed indirectly. 313 /// \param ValueInfo - The size and alignment of this type, generally 314 /// computed with getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(ValueTy). 315 /// \param SlotSizeAndAlign - The size and alignment of a stack slot. 316 /// Each argument will be allocated to a multiple of this number of 317 /// slots, and all the slots will be aligned to this value. 318 /// \param AllowHigherAlign - The slot alignment is not a cap; 319 /// an argument type with an alignment greater than the slot size 320 /// will be emitted on a higher-alignment address, potentially 321 /// leaving one or more empty slots behind as padding. 322 static Address emitVoidPtrVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 323 QualType ValueTy, bool IsIndirect, 324 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> ValueInfo, 325 CharUnits SlotSizeAndAlign, 326 bool AllowHigherAlign) { 327 // The size and alignment of the value that was passed directly. 328 CharUnits DirectSize, DirectAlign; 329 if (IsIndirect) { 330 DirectSize = CGF.getPointerSize(); 331 DirectAlign = CGF.getPointerAlign(); 332 } else { 333 DirectSize = ValueInfo.first; 334 DirectAlign = ValueInfo.second; 335 } 336 337 // Cast the address we've calculated to the right type. 338 llvm::Type *DirectTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(ValueTy); 339 if (IsIndirect) 340 DirectTy = DirectTy->getPointerTo(0); 341 342 Address Addr = emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, DirectTy, 343 DirectSize, DirectAlign, 344 SlotSizeAndAlign, 345 AllowHigherAlign); 346 347 if (IsIndirect) { 348 Addr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(Addr), ValueInfo.second); 349 } 350 351 return Addr; 352 353 } 354 355 static Address emitMergePHI(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 356 Address Addr1, llvm::BasicBlock *Block1, 357 Address Addr2, llvm::BasicBlock *Block2, 358 const llvm::Twine &Name = "") { 359 assert(Addr1.getType() == Addr2.getType()); 360 llvm::PHINode *PHI = CGF.Builder.CreatePHI(Addr1.getType(), 2, Name); 361 PHI->addIncoming(Addr1.getPointer(), Block1); 362 PHI->addIncoming(Addr2.getPointer(), Block2); 363 CharUnits Align = std::min(Addr1.getAlignment(), Addr2.getAlignment()); 364 return Address(PHI, Align); 365 } 366 367 TargetCodeGenInfo::~TargetCodeGenInfo() { delete Info; } 368 369 // If someone can figure out a general rule for this, that would be great. 370 // It's probably just doomed to be platform-dependent, though. 371 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getSizeOfUnwindException() const { 372 // Verified for: 373 // x86-64 FreeBSD, Linux, Darwin 374 // x86-32 FreeBSD, Linux, Darwin 375 // PowerPC Linux, Darwin 376 // ARM Darwin (*not* EABI) 377 // AArch64 Linux 378 return 32; 379 } 380 381 bool TargetCodeGenInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args, 382 const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const { 383 // The following conventions are known to require this to be false: 384 // x86_stdcall 385 // MIPS 386 // For everything else, we just prefer false unless we opt out. 387 return false; 388 } 389 390 void 391 TargetCodeGenInfo::getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 392 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const { 393 // This assumes the user is passing a library name like "rt" instead of a 394 // filename like "librt.a/so", and that they don't care whether it's static or 395 // dynamic. 396 Opt = "-l"; 397 Opt += Lib; 398 } 399 400 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const { 401 // OpenCL kernels are called via an explicit runtime API with arguments 402 // set with clSetKernelArg(), not as normal sub-functions. 403 // Return SPIR_KERNEL by default as the kernel calling convention to 404 // ensure the fingerprint is fixed such way that each OpenCL argument 405 // gets one matching argument in the produced kernel function argument 406 // list to enable feasible implementation of clSetKernelArg() with 407 // aggregates etc. In case we would use the default C calling conv here, 408 // clSetKernelArg() might break depending on the target-specific 409 // conventions; different targets might split structs passed as values 410 // to multiple function arguments etc. 411 return llvm::CallingConv::SPIR_KERNEL; 412 } 413 414 llvm::Constant *TargetCodeGenInfo::getNullPointer(const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 415 llvm::PointerType *T, QualType QT) const { 416 return llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(T); 417 } 418 419 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM, 420 const VarDecl *D) const { 421 assert(!CGM.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 422 !(CGM.getLangOpts().CUDA && CGM.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) && 423 "Address space agnostic languages only"); 424 return D ? D->getType().getAddressSpace() 425 : static_cast<unsigned>(LangAS::Default); 426 } 427 428 llvm::Value *TargetCodeGenInfo::performAddrSpaceCast( 429 CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, llvm::Value *Src, unsigned SrcAddr, 430 unsigned DestAddr, llvm::Type *DestTy, bool isNonNull) const { 431 // Since target may map different address spaces in AST to the same address 432 // space, an address space conversion may end up as a bitcast. 433 if (auto *C = dyn_cast<llvm::Constant>(Src)) 434 return performAddrSpaceCast(CGF.CGM, C, SrcAddr, DestAddr, DestTy); 435 return CGF.Builder.CreatePointerBitCastOrAddrSpaceCast(Src, DestTy); 436 } 437 438 llvm::Constant * 439 TargetCodeGenInfo::performAddrSpaceCast(CodeGenModule &CGM, llvm::Constant *Src, 440 unsigned SrcAddr, unsigned DestAddr, 441 llvm::Type *DestTy) const { 442 // Since target may map different address spaces in AST to the same address 443 // space, an address space conversion may end up as a bitcast. 444 return llvm::ConstantExpr::getPointerCast(Src, DestTy); 445 } 446 447 static bool isEmptyRecord(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, bool AllowArrays); 448 449 /// isEmptyField - Return true iff a the field is "empty", that is it 450 /// is an unnamed bit-field or an (array of) empty record(s). 451 static bool isEmptyField(ASTContext &Context, const FieldDecl *FD, 452 bool AllowArrays) { 453 if (FD->isUnnamedBitfield()) 454 return true; 455 456 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 457 458 // Constant arrays of empty records count as empty, strip them off. 459 // Constant arrays of zero length always count as empty. 460 if (AllowArrays) 461 while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) { 462 if (AT->getSize() == 0) 463 return true; 464 FT = AT->getElementType(); 465 } 466 467 const RecordType *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>(); 468 if (!RT) 469 return false; 470 471 // C++ record fields are never empty, at least in the Itanium ABI. 472 // 473 // FIXME: We should use a predicate for whether this behavior is true in the 474 // current ABI. 475 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl())) 476 return false; 477 478 return isEmptyRecord(Context, FT, AllowArrays); 479 } 480 481 /// isEmptyRecord - Return true iff a structure contains only empty 482 /// fields. Note that a structure with a flexible array member is not 483 /// considered empty. 484 static bool isEmptyRecord(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, bool AllowArrays) { 485 const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 486 if (!RT) 487 return false; 488 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 489 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 490 return false; 491 492 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 493 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 494 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) 495 if (!isEmptyRecord(Context, I.getType(), true)) 496 return false; 497 498 for (const auto *I : RD->fields()) 499 if (!isEmptyField(Context, I, AllowArrays)) 500 return false; 501 return true; 502 } 503 504 /// isSingleElementStruct - Determine if a structure is a "single 505 /// element struct", i.e. it has exactly one non-empty field or 506 /// exactly one field which is itself a single element 507 /// struct. Structures with flexible array members are never 508 /// considered single element structs. 509 /// 510 /// \return The field declaration for the single non-empty field, if 511 /// it exists. 512 static const Type *isSingleElementStruct(QualType T, ASTContext &Context) { 513 const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 514 if (!RT) 515 return nullptr; 516 517 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 518 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 519 return nullptr; 520 521 const Type *Found = nullptr; 522 523 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 524 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 525 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 526 // Ignore empty records. 527 if (isEmptyRecord(Context, I.getType(), true)) 528 continue; 529 530 // If we already found an element then this isn't a single-element struct. 531 if (Found) 532 return nullptr; 533 534 // If this is non-empty and not a single element struct, the composite 535 // cannot be a single element struct. 536 Found = isSingleElementStruct(I.getType(), Context); 537 if (!Found) 538 return nullptr; 539 } 540 } 541 542 // Check for single element. 543 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 544 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 545 546 // Ignore empty fields. 547 if (isEmptyField(Context, FD, true)) 548 continue; 549 550 // If we already found an element then this isn't a single-element 551 // struct. 552 if (Found) 553 return nullptr; 554 555 // Treat single element arrays as the element. 556 while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) { 557 if (AT->getSize().getZExtValue() != 1) 558 break; 559 FT = AT->getElementType(); 560 } 561 562 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(FT)) { 563 Found = FT.getTypePtr(); 564 } else { 565 Found = isSingleElementStruct(FT, Context); 566 if (!Found) 567 return nullptr; 568 } 569 } 570 571 // We don't consider a struct a single-element struct if it has 572 // padding beyond the element type. 573 if (Found && Context.getTypeSize(Found) != Context.getTypeSize(T)) 574 return nullptr; 575 576 return Found; 577 } 578 579 namespace { 580 Address EmitVAArgInstr(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 581 const ABIArgInfo &AI) { 582 // This default implementation defers to the llvm backend's va_arg 583 // instruction. It can handle only passing arguments directly 584 // (typically only handled in the backend for primitive types), or 585 // aggregates passed indirectly by pointer (NOTE: if the "byval" 586 // flag has ABI impact in the callee, this implementation cannot 587 // work.) 588 589 // Only a few cases are covered here at the moment -- those needed 590 // by the default abi. 591 llvm::Value *Val; 592 593 if (AI.isIndirect()) { 594 assert(!AI.getPaddingType() && 595 "Unexpected PaddingType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 596 assert( 597 !AI.getIndirectRealign() && 598 "Unexpected IndirectRealign seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 599 600 auto TyInfo = CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 601 CharUnits TyAlignForABI = TyInfo.second; 602 603 llvm::Type *BaseTy = 604 llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty)); 605 llvm::Value *Addr = 606 CGF.Builder.CreateVAArg(VAListAddr.getPointer(), BaseTy); 607 return Address(Addr, TyAlignForABI); 608 } else { 609 assert((AI.isDirect() || AI.isExtend()) && 610 "Unexpected ArgInfo Kind in generic VAArg emitter!"); 611 612 assert(!AI.getInReg() && 613 "Unexpected InReg seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 614 assert(!AI.getPaddingType() && 615 "Unexpected PaddingType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 616 assert(!AI.getDirectOffset() && 617 "Unexpected DirectOffset seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 618 assert(!AI.getCoerceToType() && 619 "Unexpected CoerceToType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!"); 620 621 Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty, "varet"); 622 Val = CGF.Builder.CreateVAArg(VAListAddr.getPointer(), CGF.ConvertType(Ty)); 623 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(Val, Temp); 624 return Temp; 625 } 626 } 627 628 /// DefaultABIInfo - The default implementation for ABI specific 629 /// details. This implementation provides information which results in 630 /// self-consistent and sensible LLVM IR generation, but does not 631 /// conform to any particular ABI. 632 class DefaultABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 633 public: 634 DefaultABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 635 636 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 637 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 638 639 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 640 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 641 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 642 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 643 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 644 } 645 646 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 647 QualType Ty) const override { 648 return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, classifyArgumentType(Ty)); 649 } 650 }; 651 652 class DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 653 public: 654 DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 655 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {} 656 }; 657 658 ABIArgInfo DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 659 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 660 661 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 662 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 663 // passed by value. 664 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 665 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 666 667 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty); 668 } 669 670 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 671 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 672 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 673 674 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 675 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 676 } 677 678 ABIArgInfo DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 679 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 680 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 681 682 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) 683 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 684 685 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 686 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 687 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 688 689 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 690 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 691 } 692 693 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 694 // WebAssembly ABI Implementation 695 // 696 // This is a very simple ABI that relies a lot on DefaultABIInfo. 697 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 698 699 class WebAssemblyABIInfo final : public DefaultABIInfo { 700 public: 701 explicit WebAssemblyABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 702 : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 703 704 private: 705 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 706 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 707 708 // DefaultABIInfo's classifyReturnType and classifyArgumentType are 709 // non-virtual, but computeInfo and EmitVAArg are virtual, so we 710 // overload them. 711 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 712 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 713 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 714 for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments()) 715 Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type); 716 } 717 718 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 719 QualType Ty) const override; 720 }; 721 722 class WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo final : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 723 public: 724 explicit WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 725 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new WebAssemblyABIInfo(CGT)) {} 726 }; 727 728 /// \brief Classify argument of given type \p Ty. 729 ABIArgInfo WebAssemblyABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 730 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 731 732 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 733 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 734 // passed by value. 735 if (auto RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 736 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 737 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 738 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 739 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 740 // Lower single-element structs to just pass a regular value. TODO: We 741 // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using getExpand(), 742 // though watch out for things like bitfields. 743 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext())) 744 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 745 } 746 747 // Otherwise just do the default thing. 748 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty); 749 } 750 751 ABIArgInfo WebAssemblyABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 752 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 753 // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be 754 // returned by value. 755 if (!getRecordArgABI(RetTy, getCXXABI())) { 756 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 757 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 758 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 759 // Lower single-element structs to just return a regular value. TODO: We 760 // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using 761 // ABIArgInfo::getDirect(). 762 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext())) 763 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 764 } 765 } 766 767 // Otherwise just do the default thing. 768 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy); 769 } 770 771 Address WebAssemblyABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 772 QualType Ty) const { 773 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect=*/ false, 774 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 775 CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 776 /*AllowHigherAlign=*/ true); 777 } 778 779 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 780 // le32/PNaCl bitcode ABI Implementation 781 // 782 // This is a simplified version of the x86_32 ABI. Arguments and return values 783 // are always passed on the stack. 784 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 785 786 class PNaClABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 787 public: 788 PNaClABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 789 790 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 791 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 792 793 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 794 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 795 Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) const override; 796 }; 797 798 class PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 799 public: 800 PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 801 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PNaClABIInfo(CGT)) {} 802 }; 803 804 void PNaClABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 805 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 806 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 807 808 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 809 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 810 } 811 812 Address PNaClABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 813 QualType Ty) const { 814 // The PNaCL ABI is a bit odd, in that varargs don't use normal 815 // function classification. Structs get passed directly for varargs 816 // functions, through a rewriting transform in 817 // pnacl-llvm/lib/Transforms/NaCl/ExpandVarArgs.cpp, which allows 818 // this target to actually support a va_arg instructions with an 819 // aggregate type, unlike other targets. 820 return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 821 } 822 823 /// \brief Classify argument of given type \p Ty. 824 ABIArgInfo PNaClABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 825 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 826 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 827 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 828 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty); 829 } else if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) { 830 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 831 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 832 } else if (Ty->isFloatingType()) { 833 // Floating-point types don't go inreg. 834 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 835 } 836 837 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 838 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 839 } 840 841 ABIArgInfo PNaClABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 842 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 843 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 844 845 // In the PNaCl ABI we always return records/structures on the stack. 846 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) 847 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 848 849 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 850 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 851 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 852 853 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 854 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 855 } 856 857 /// IsX86_MMXType - Return true if this is an MMX type. 858 bool IsX86_MMXType(llvm::Type *IRType) { 859 // Return true if the type is an MMX type <2 x i32>, <4 x i16>, or <8 x i8>. 860 return IRType->isVectorTy() && IRType->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() == 64 && 861 cast<llvm::VectorType>(IRType)->getElementType()->isIntegerTy() && 862 IRType->getScalarSizeInBits() != 64; 863 } 864 865 static llvm::Type* X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 866 StringRef Constraint, 867 llvm::Type* Ty) { 868 if ((Constraint == "y" || Constraint == "&y") && Ty->isVectorTy()) { 869 if (cast<llvm::VectorType>(Ty)->getBitWidth() != 64) { 870 // Invalid MMX constraint 871 return nullptr; 872 } 873 874 return llvm::Type::getX86_MMXTy(CGF.getLLVMContext()); 875 } 876 877 // No operation needed 878 return Ty; 879 } 880 881 /// Returns true if this type can be passed in SSE registers with the 882 /// X86_VectorCall calling convention. Shared between x86_32 and x86_64. 883 static bool isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) { 884 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 885 if (BT->isFloatingPoint() && BT->getKind() != BuiltinType::Half) 886 return true; 887 } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 888 // vectorcall can pass XMM, YMM, and ZMM vectors. We don't pass SSE1 MMX 889 // registers specially. 890 unsigned VecSize = Context.getTypeSize(VT); 891 if (VecSize == 128 || VecSize == 256 || VecSize == 512) 892 return true; 893 } 894 return false; 895 } 896 897 /// Returns true if this aggregate is small enough to be passed in SSE registers 898 /// in the X86_VectorCall calling convention. Shared between x86_32 and x86_64. 899 static bool isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(uint64_t NumMembers) { 900 return NumMembers <= 4; 901 } 902 903 /// Returns a Homogeneous Vector Aggregate ABIArgInfo, used in X86. 904 static ABIArgInfo getDirectX86Hva(llvm::Type* T = nullptr) { 905 auto AI = ABIArgInfo::getDirect(T); 906 AI.setInReg(true); 907 AI.setCanBeFlattened(false); 908 return AI; 909 } 910 911 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 912 // X86-32 ABI Implementation 913 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 914 915 /// \brief Similar to llvm::CCState, but for Clang. 916 struct CCState { 917 CCState(unsigned CC) : CC(CC), FreeRegs(0), FreeSSERegs(0) {} 918 919 unsigned CC; 920 unsigned FreeRegs; 921 unsigned FreeSSERegs; 922 }; 923 924 enum { 925 // Vectorcall only allows the first 6 parameters to be passed in registers. 926 VectorcallMaxParamNumAsReg = 6 927 }; 928 929 /// X86_32ABIInfo - The X86-32 ABI information. 930 class X86_32ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 931 enum Class { 932 Integer, 933 Float 934 }; 935 936 static const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4; 937 938 bool IsDarwinVectorABI; 939 bool IsRetSmallStructInRegABI; 940 bool IsWin32StructABI; 941 bool IsSoftFloatABI; 942 bool IsMCUABI; 943 unsigned DefaultNumRegisterParameters; 944 945 static bool isRegisterSize(unsigned Size) { 946 return (Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32 || Size == 64); 947 } 948 949 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override { 950 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 951 return isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(getContext(), Ty); 952 } 953 954 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 955 uint64_t NumMembers) const override { 956 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 957 return isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(NumMembers); 958 } 959 960 bool shouldReturnTypeInRegister(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context) const; 961 962 /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result 963 /// such that the argument will be passed in memory. 964 ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, CCState &State) const; 965 966 ABIArgInfo getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 967 968 /// \brief Return the alignment to use for the given type on the stack. 969 unsigned getTypeStackAlignInBytes(QualType Ty, unsigned Align) const; 970 971 Class classify(QualType Ty) const; 972 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const; 973 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const; 974 975 /// \brief Updates the number of available free registers, returns 976 /// true if any registers were allocated. 977 bool updateFreeRegs(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 978 979 bool shouldAggregateUseDirect(QualType Ty, CCState &State, bool &InReg, 980 bool &NeedsPadding) const; 981 bool shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 982 983 bool canExpandIndirectArgument(QualType Ty) const; 984 985 /// \brief Rewrite the function info so that all memory arguments use 986 /// inalloca. 987 void rewriteWithInAlloca(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const; 988 989 void addFieldToArgStruct(SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> &FrameFields, 990 CharUnits &StackOffset, ABIArgInfo &Info, 991 QualType Type) const; 992 void computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, CCState &State, 993 bool &UsedInAlloca) const; 994 995 public: 996 997 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 998 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 999 QualType Ty) const override; 1000 1001 X86_32ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool DarwinVectorABI, 1002 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI, 1003 unsigned NumRegisterParameters, bool SoftFloatABI) 1004 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), IsDarwinVectorABI(DarwinVectorABI), 1005 IsRetSmallStructInRegABI(RetSmallStructInRegABI), 1006 IsWin32StructABI(Win32StructABI), 1007 IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI), 1008 IsMCUABI(CGT.getTarget().getTriple().isOSIAMCU()), 1009 DefaultNumRegisterParameters(NumRegisterParameters) {} 1010 1011 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 1012 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 1013 bool asReturnValue) const override { 1014 // LLVM's x86-32 lowering currently only assigns up to three 1015 // integer registers and three fp registers. Oddly, it'll use up to 1016 // four vector registers for vectors, but those can overlap with the 1017 // scalar registers. 1018 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 3); 1019 } 1020 1021 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 1022 // x86-32 lowering does not support passing swifterror in a register. 1023 return false; 1024 } 1025 }; 1026 1027 class X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 1028 public: 1029 X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool DarwinVectorABI, 1030 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI, 1031 unsigned NumRegisterParameters, bool SoftFloatABI) 1032 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new X86_32ABIInfo( 1033 CGT, DarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, Win32StructABI, 1034 NumRegisterParameters, SoftFloatABI)) {} 1035 1036 static bool isStructReturnInRegABI( 1037 const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts); 1038 1039 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 1040 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 1041 1042 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 1043 // Darwin uses different dwarf register numbers for EH. 1044 if (CGM.getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) return 5; 1045 return 4; 1046 } 1047 1048 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 1049 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 1050 1051 llvm::Type* adjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 1052 StringRef Constraint, 1053 llvm::Type* Ty) const override { 1054 return X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CGF, Constraint, Ty); 1055 } 1056 1057 void addReturnRegisterOutputs(CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue ReturnValue, 1058 std::string &Constraints, 1059 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultRegTypes, 1060 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultTruncRegTypes, 1061 std::vector<LValue> &ResultRegDests, 1062 std::string &AsmString, 1063 unsigned NumOutputs) const override; 1064 1065 llvm::Constant * 1066 getUBSanFunctionSignature(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 1067 unsigned Sig = (0xeb << 0) | // jmp rel8 1068 (0x06 << 8) | // .+0x08 1069 ('F' << 16) | 1070 ('T' << 24); 1071 return llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGM.Int32Ty, Sig); 1072 } 1073 1074 StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override { 1075 return "movl\t%ebp, %ebp" 1076 "\t\t## marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue"; 1077 } 1078 }; 1079 1080 } 1081 1082 /// Rewrite input constraint references after adding some output constraints. 1083 /// In the case where there is one output and one input and we add one output, 1084 /// we need to replace all operand references greater than or equal to 1: 1085 /// mov $0, $1 1086 /// mov eax, $1 1087 /// The result will be: 1088 /// mov $0, $2 1089 /// mov eax, $2 1090 static void rewriteInputConstraintReferences(unsigned FirstIn, 1091 unsigned NumNewOuts, 1092 std::string &AsmString) { 1093 std::string Buf; 1094 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(Buf); 1095 size_t Pos = 0; 1096 while (Pos < AsmString.size()) { 1097 size_t DollarStart = AsmString.find('$', Pos); 1098 if (DollarStart == std::string::npos) 1099 DollarStart = AsmString.size(); 1100 size_t DollarEnd = AsmString.find_first_not_of('$', DollarStart); 1101 if (DollarEnd == std::string::npos) 1102 DollarEnd = AsmString.size(); 1103 OS << StringRef(&AsmString[Pos], DollarEnd - Pos); 1104 Pos = DollarEnd; 1105 size_t NumDollars = DollarEnd - DollarStart; 1106 if (NumDollars % 2 != 0 && Pos < AsmString.size()) { 1107 // We have an operand reference. 1108 size_t DigitStart = Pos; 1109 size_t DigitEnd = AsmString.find_first_not_of("0123456789", DigitStart); 1110 if (DigitEnd == std::string::npos) 1111 DigitEnd = AsmString.size(); 1112 StringRef OperandStr(&AsmString[DigitStart], DigitEnd - DigitStart); 1113 unsigned OperandIndex; 1114 if (!OperandStr.getAsInteger(10, OperandIndex)) { 1115 if (OperandIndex >= FirstIn) 1116 OperandIndex += NumNewOuts; 1117 OS << OperandIndex; 1118 } else { 1119 OS << OperandStr; 1120 } 1121 Pos = DigitEnd; 1122 } 1123 } 1124 AsmString = std::move(OS.str()); 1125 } 1126 1127 /// Add output constraints for EAX:EDX because they are return registers. 1128 void X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::addReturnRegisterOutputs( 1129 CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue ReturnSlot, std::string &Constraints, 1130 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultRegTypes, 1131 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultTruncRegTypes, 1132 std::vector<LValue> &ResultRegDests, std::string &AsmString, 1133 unsigned NumOutputs) const { 1134 uint64_t RetWidth = CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(ReturnSlot.getType()); 1135 1136 // Use the EAX constraint if the width is 32 or smaller and EAX:EDX if it is 1137 // larger. 1138 if (!Constraints.empty()) 1139 Constraints += ','; 1140 if (RetWidth <= 32) { 1141 Constraints += "={eax}"; 1142 ResultRegTypes.push_back(CGF.Int32Ty); 1143 } else { 1144 // Use the 'A' constraint for EAX:EDX. 1145 Constraints += "=A"; 1146 ResultRegTypes.push_back(CGF.Int64Ty); 1147 } 1148 1149 // Truncate EAX or EAX:EDX to an integer of the appropriate size. 1150 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(CGF.getLLVMContext(), RetWidth); 1151 ResultTruncRegTypes.push_back(CoerceTy); 1152 1153 // Coerce the integer by bitcasting the return slot pointer. 1154 ReturnSlot.setAddress(CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(ReturnSlot.getAddress(), 1155 CoerceTy->getPointerTo())); 1156 ResultRegDests.push_back(ReturnSlot); 1157 1158 rewriteInputConstraintReferences(NumOutputs, 1, AsmString); 1159 } 1160 1161 /// shouldReturnTypeInRegister - Determine if the given type should be 1162 /// returned in a register (for the Darwin and MCU ABI). 1163 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldReturnTypeInRegister(QualType Ty, 1164 ASTContext &Context) const { 1165 uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 1166 1167 // For i386, type must be register sized. 1168 // For the MCU ABI, it only needs to be <= 8-byte 1169 if ((IsMCUABI && Size > 64) || (!IsMCUABI && !isRegisterSize(Size))) 1170 return false; 1171 1172 if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 1173 // 64- and 128- bit vectors inside structures are not returned in 1174 // registers. 1175 if (Size == 64 || Size == 128) 1176 return false; 1177 1178 return true; 1179 } 1180 1181 // If this is a builtin, pointer, enum, complex type, member pointer, or 1182 // member function pointer it is ok. 1183 if (Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() || Ty->hasPointerRepresentation() || 1184 Ty->isAnyComplexType() || Ty->isEnumeralType() || 1185 Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) 1186 return true; 1187 1188 // Arrays are treated like records. 1189 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) 1190 return shouldReturnTypeInRegister(AT->getElementType(), Context); 1191 1192 // Otherwise, it must be a record type. 1193 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1194 if (!RT) return false; 1195 1196 // FIXME: Traverse bases here too. 1197 1198 // Structure types are passed in register if all fields would be 1199 // passed in a register. 1200 for (const auto *FD : RT->getDecl()->fields()) { 1201 // Empty fields are ignored. 1202 if (isEmptyField(Context, FD, true)) 1203 continue; 1204 1205 // Check fields recursively. 1206 if (!shouldReturnTypeInRegister(FD->getType(), Context)) 1207 return false; 1208 } 1209 return true; 1210 } 1211 1212 static bool is32Or64BitBasicType(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context) { 1213 // Treat complex types as the element type. 1214 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) 1215 Ty = CTy->getElementType(); 1216 1217 // Check for a type which we know has a simple scalar argument-passing 1218 // convention without any padding. (We're specifically looking for 32 1219 // and 64-bit integer and integer-equivalents, float, and double.) 1220 if (!Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() && !Ty->hasPointerRepresentation() && 1221 !Ty->isEnumeralType() && !Ty->isBlockPointerType()) 1222 return false; 1223 1224 uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 1225 return Size == 32 || Size == 64; 1226 } 1227 1228 static bool addFieldSizes(ASTContext &Context, const RecordDecl *RD, 1229 uint64_t &Size) { 1230 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 1231 // Scalar arguments on the stack get 4 byte alignment on x86. If the 1232 // argument is smaller than 32-bits, expanding the struct will create 1233 // alignment padding. 1234 if (!is32Or64BitBasicType(FD->getType(), Context)) 1235 return false; 1236 1237 // FIXME: Reject bit-fields wholesale; there are two problems, we don't know 1238 // how to expand them yet, and the predicate for telling if a bitfield still 1239 // counts as "basic" is more complicated than what we were doing previously. 1240 if (FD->isBitField()) 1241 return false; 1242 1243 Size += Context.getTypeSize(FD->getType()); 1244 } 1245 return true; 1246 } 1247 1248 static bool addBaseAndFieldSizes(ASTContext &Context, const CXXRecordDecl *RD, 1249 uint64_t &Size) { 1250 // Don't do this if there are any non-empty bases. 1251 for (const CXXBaseSpecifier &Base : RD->bases()) { 1252 if (!addBaseAndFieldSizes(Context, Base.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(), 1253 Size)) 1254 return false; 1255 } 1256 if (!addFieldSizes(Context, RD, Size)) 1257 return false; 1258 return true; 1259 } 1260 1261 /// Test whether an argument type which is to be passed indirectly (on the 1262 /// stack) would have the equivalent layout if it was expanded into separate 1263 /// arguments. If so, we prefer to do the latter to avoid inhibiting 1264 /// optimizations. 1265 bool X86_32ABIInfo::canExpandIndirectArgument(QualType Ty) const { 1266 // We can only expand structure types. 1267 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1268 if (!RT) 1269 return false; 1270 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 1271 uint64_t Size = 0; 1272 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 1273 if (!IsWin32StructABI) { 1274 // On non-Windows, we have to conservatively match our old bitcode 1275 // prototypes in order to be ABI-compatible at the bitcode level. 1276 if (!CXXRD->isCLike()) 1277 return false; 1278 } else { 1279 // Don't do this for dynamic classes. 1280 if (CXXRD->isDynamicClass()) 1281 return false; 1282 } 1283 if (!addBaseAndFieldSizes(getContext(), CXXRD, Size)) 1284 return false; 1285 } else { 1286 if (!addFieldSizes(getContext(), RD, Size)) 1287 return false; 1288 } 1289 1290 // We can do this if there was no alignment padding. 1291 return Size == getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 1292 } 1293 1294 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::getIndirectReturnResult(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const { 1295 // If the return value is indirect, then the hidden argument is consuming one 1296 // integer register. 1297 if (State.FreeRegs) { 1298 --State.FreeRegs; 1299 if (!IsMCUABI) 1300 return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(RetTy); 1301 } 1302 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/false); 1303 } 1304 1305 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, 1306 CCState &State) const { 1307 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 1308 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 1309 1310 const Type *Base = nullptr; 1311 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 1312 if ((State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall || 1313 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) && 1314 isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, NumElts)) { 1315 // The LLVM struct type for such an aggregate should lower properly. 1316 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1317 } 1318 1319 if (const VectorType *VT = RetTy->getAs<VectorType>()) { 1320 // On Darwin, some vectors are returned in registers. 1321 if (IsDarwinVectorABI) { 1322 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 1323 1324 // 128-bit vectors are a special case; they are returned in 1325 // registers and we need to make sure to pick a type the LLVM 1326 // backend will like. 1327 if (Size == 128) 1328 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::VectorType::get( 1329 llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()), 2)); 1330 1331 // Always return in register if it fits in a general purpose 1332 // register, or if it is 64 bits and has a single element. 1333 if ((Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) || 1334 (Size == 64 && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) 1335 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 1336 Size)); 1337 1338 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1339 } 1340 1341 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1342 } 1343 1344 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 1345 if (const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 1346 // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect. 1347 if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 1348 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1349 } 1350 1351 // If specified, structs and unions are always indirect. 1352 if (!IsRetSmallStructInRegABI && !RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 1353 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1354 1355 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 1356 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 1357 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 1358 1359 // Small structures which are register sized are generally returned 1360 // in a register. 1361 if (shouldReturnTypeInRegister(RetTy, getContext())) { 1362 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 1363 1364 // As a special-case, if the struct is a "single-element" struct, and 1365 // the field is of type "float" or "double", return it in a 1366 // floating-point register. (MSVC does not apply this special case.) 1367 // We apply a similar transformation for pointer types to improve the 1368 // quality of the generated IR. 1369 if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext())) 1370 if ((!IsWin32StructABI && SeltTy->isRealFloatingType()) 1371 || SeltTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) 1372 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0))); 1373 1374 // FIXME: We should be able to narrow this integer in cases with dead 1375 // padding. 1376 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),Size)); 1377 } 1378 1379 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State); 1380 } 1381 1382 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 1383 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 1384 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 1385 1386 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 1387 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 1388 } 1389 1390 static bool isSSEVectorType(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) { 1391 return Ty->getAs<VectorType>() && Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == 128; 1392 } 1393 1394 static bool isRecordWithSSEVectorType(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) { 1395 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1396 if (!RT) 1397 return 0; 1398 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 1399 1400 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 1401 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 1402 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) 1403 if (!isRecordWithSSEVectorType(Context, I.getType())) 1404 return false; 1405 1406 for (const auto *i : RD->fields()) { 1407 QualType FT = i->getType(); 1408 1409 if (isSSEVectorType(Context, FT)) 1410 return true; 1411 1412 if (isRecordWithSSEVectorType(Context, FT)) 1413 return true; 1414 } 1415 1416 return false; 1417 } 1418 1419 unsigned X86_32ABIInfo::getTypeStackAlignInBytes(QualType Ty, 1420 unsigned Align) const { 1421 // Otherwise, if the alignment is less than or equal to the minimum ABI 1422 // alignment, just use the default; the backend will handle this. 1423 if (Align <= MinABIStackAlignInBytes) 1424 return 0; // Use default alignment. 1425 1426 // On non-Darwin, the stack type alignment is always 4. 1427 if (!IsDarwinVectorABI) { 1428 // Set explicit alignment, since we may need to realign the top. 1429 return MinABIStackAlignInBytes; 1430 } 1431 1432 // Otherwise, if the type contains an SSE vector type, the alignment is 16. 1433 if (Align >= 16 && (isSSEVectorType(getContext(), Ty) || 1434 isRecordWithSSEVectorType(getContext(), Ty))) 1435 return 16; 1436 1437 return MinABIStackAlignInBytes; 1438 } 1439 1440 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, 1441 CCState &State) const { 1442 if (!ByVal) { 1443 if (State.FreeRegs) { 1444 --State.FreeRegs; // Non-byval indirects just use one pointer. 1445 if (!IsMCUABI) 1446 return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty); 1447 } 1448 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false); 1449 } 1450 1451 // Compute the byval alignment. 1452 unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 1453 unsigned StackAlign = getTypeStackAlignInBytes(Ty, TypeAlign); 1454 if (StackAlign == 0) 1455 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true); 1456 1457 // If the stack alignment is less than the type alignment, realign the 1458 // argument. 1459 bool Realign = TypeAlign > StackAlign; 1460 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(StackAlign), 1461 /*ByVal=*/true, Realign); 1462 } 1463 1464 X86_32ABIInfo::Class X86_32ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty) const { 1465 const Type *T = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()); 1466 if (!T) 1467 T = Ty.getTypePtr(); 1468 1469 if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 1470 BuiltinType::Kind K = BT->getKind(); 1471 if (K == BuiltinType::Float || K == BuiltinType::Double) 1472 return Float; 1473 } 1474 return Integer; 1475 } 1476 1477 bool X86_32ABIInfo::updateFreeRegs(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const { 1478 if (!IsSoftFloatABI) { 1479 Class C = classify(Ty); 1480 if (C == Float) 1481 return false; 1482 } 1483 1484 unsigned Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 1485 unsigned SizeInRegs = (Size + 31) / 32; 1486 1487 if (SizeInRegs == 0) 1488 return false; 1489 1490 if (!IsMCUABI) { 1491 if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs) { 1492 State.FreeRegs = 0; 1493 return false; 1494 } 1495 } else { 1496 // The MCU psABI allows passing parameters in-reg even if there are 1497 // earlier parameters that are passed on the stack. Also, 1498 // it does not allow passing >8-byte structs in-register, 1499 // even if there are 3 free registers available. 1500 if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs || SizeInRegs > 2) 1501 return false; 1502 } 1503 1504 State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs; 1505 return true; 1506 } 1507 1508 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldAggregateUseDirect(QualType Ty, CCState &State, 1509 bool &InReg, 1510 bool &NeedsPadding) const { 1511 // On Windows, aggregates other than HFAs are never passed in registers, and 1512 // they do not consume register slots. Homogenous floating-point aggregates 1513 // (HFAs) have already been dealt with at this point. 1514 if (IsWin32StructABI && isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) 1515 return false; 1516 1517 NeedsPadding = false; 1518 InReg = !IsMCUABI; 1519 1520 if (!updateFreeRegs(Ty, State)) 1521 return false; 1522 1523 if (IsMCUABI) 1524 return true; 1525 1526 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall || 1527 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall || 1528 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) { 1529 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 32 && State.FreeRegs) 1530 NeedsPadding = true; 1531 1532 return false; 1533 } 1534 1535 return true; 1536 } 1537 1538 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const { 1539 if (!updateFreeRegs(Ty, State)) 1540 return false; 1541 1542 if (IsMCUABI) 1543 return false; 1544 1545 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall || 1546 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall || 1547 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) { 1548 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) > 32) 1549 return false; 1550 1551 return (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || Ty->isPointerType() || 1552 Ty->isReferenceType()); 1553 } 1554 1555 return true; 1556 } 1557 1558 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 1559 CCState &State) const { 1560 // FIXME: Set alignment on indirect arguments. 1561 1562 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 1563 1564 // Check with the C++ ABI first. 1565 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 1566 if (RT) { 1567 CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()); 1568 if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) { 1569 return getIndirectResult(Ty, false, State); 1570 } else if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) { 1571 // The field index doesn't matter, we'll fix it up later. 1572 return ABIArgInfo::getInAlloca(/*FieldIndex=*/0); 1573 } 1574 } 1575 1576 // Regcall uses the concept of a homogenous vector aggregate, similar 1577 // to other targets. 1578 const Type *Base = nullptr; 1579 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 1580 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall && 1581 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) { 1582 1583 if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 1584 State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 1585 if (Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType()) 1586 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1587 return ABIArgInfo::getExpand(); 1588 } 1589 return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State); 1590 } 1591 1592 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 1593 // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect. 1594 // FIXME: This should not be byval! 1595 if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 1596 return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State); 1597 1598 // Ignore empty structs/unions on non-Windows. 1599 if (!IsWin32StructABI && isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 1600 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 1601 1602 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext(); 1603 llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext); 1604 bool NeedsPadding = false; 1605 bool InReg; 1606 if (shouldAggregateUseDirect(Ty, State, InReg, NeedsPadding)) { 1607 unsigned SizeInRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 1608 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32); 1609 llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements); 1610 if (InReg) 1611 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result); 1612 else 1613 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Result); 1614 } 1615 llvm::IntegerType *PaddingType = NeedsPadding ? Int32 : nullptr; 1616 1617 // Expand small (<= 128-bit) record types when we know that the stack layout 1618 // of those arguments will match the struct. This is important because the 1619 // LLVM backend isn't smart enough to remove byval, which inhibits many 1620 // optimizations. 1621 // Don't do this for the MCU if there are still free integer registers 1622 // (see X86_64 ABI for full explanation). 1623 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 4 * 32 && 1624 (!IsMCUABI || State.FreeRegs == 0) && canExpandIndirectArgument(Ty)) 1625 return ABIArgInfo::getExpandWithPadding( 1626 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall || 1627 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall || 1628 State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall, 1629 PaddingType); 1630 1631 return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State); 1632 } 1633 1634 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 1635 // On Darwin, some vectors are passed in memory, we handle this by passing 1636 // it as an i8/i16/i32/i64. 1637 if (IsDarwinVectorABI) { 1638 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 1639 if ((Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) || 1640 (Size == 64 && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) 1641 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 1642 Size)); 1643 } 1644 1645 if (IsX86_MMXType(CGT.ConvertType(Ty))) 1646 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 64)); 1647 1648 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1649 } 1650 1651 1652 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 1653 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 1654 1655 bool InReg = shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(Ty, State); 1656 1657 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 1658 if (InReg) 1659 return ABIArgInfo::getExtendInReg(); 1660 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 1661 } 1662 1663 if (InReg) 1664 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(); 1665 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1666 } 1667 1668 void X86_32ABIInfo::computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, CCState &State, 1669 bool &UsedInAlloca) const { 1670 // Vectorcall x86 works subtly different than in x64, so the format is 1671 // a bit different than the x64 version. First, all vector types (not HVAs) 1672 // are assigned, with the first 6 ending up in the YMM0-5 or XMM0-5 registers. 1673 // This differs from the x64 implementation, where the first 6 by INDEX get 1674 // registers. 1675 // After that, integers AND HVAs are assigned Left to Right in the same pass. 1676 // Integers are passed as ECX/EDX if one is available (in order). HVAs will 1677 // first take up the remaining YMM/XMM registers. If insufficient registers 1678 // remain but an integer register (ECX/EDX) is available, it will be passed 1679 // in that, else, on the stack. 1680 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 1681 // First pass do all the vector types. 1682 const Type *Base = nullptr; 1683 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 1684 const QualType& Ty = I.type; 1685 if ((Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isBuiltinType()) && 1686 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) { 1687 if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 1688 State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 1689 I.info = ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 1690 } else { 1691 I.info = classifyArgumentType(Ty, State); 1692 } 1693 UsedInAlloca |= (I.info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca); 1694 } 1695 } 1696 1697 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 1698 // Second pass, do the rest! 1699 const Type *Base = nullptr; 1700 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 1701 const QualType& Ty = I.type; 1702 bool IsHva = isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts); 1703 1704 if (IsHva && !Ty->isVectorType() && !Ty->isBuiltinType()) { 1705 // Assign true HVAs (non vector/native FP types). 1706 if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 1707 State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 1708 I.info = getDirectX86Hva(); 1709 } else { 1710 I.info = getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State); 1711 } 1712 } else if (!IsHva) { 1713 // Assign all Non-HVAs, so this will exclude Vector/FP args. 1714 I.info = classifyArgumentType(Ty, State); 1715 UsedInAlloca |= (I.info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca); 1716 } 1717 } 1718 } 1719 1720 void X86_32ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 1721 CCState State(FI.getCallingConvention()); 1722 if (IsMCUABI) 1723 State.FreeRegs = 3; 1724 else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall) 1725 State.FreeRegs = 2; 1726 else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall) { 1727 State.FreeRegs = 2; 1728 State.FreeSSERegs = 6; 1729 } else if (FI.getHasRegParm()) 1730 State.FreeRegs = FI.getRegParm(); 1731 else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) { 1732 State.FreeRegs = 5; 1733 State.FreeSSERegs = 8; 1734 } else 1735 State.FreeRegs = DefaultNumRegisterParameters; 1736 1737 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) { 1738 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), State); 1739 } else if (FI.getReturnInfo().isIndirect()) { 1740 // The C++ ABI is not aware of register usage, so we have to check if the 1741 // return value was sret and put it in a register ourselves if appropriate. 1742 if (State.FreeRegs) { 1743 --State.FreeRegs; // The sret parameter consumes a register. 1744 if (!IsMCUABI) 1745 FI.getReturnInfo().setInReg(true); 1746 } 1747 } 1748 1749 // The chain argument effectively gives us another free register. 1750 if (FI.isChainCall()) 1751 ++State.FreeRegs; 1752 1753 bool UsedInAlloca = false; 1754 if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall) { 1755 computeVectorCallArgs(FI, State, UsedInAlloca); 1756 } else { 1757 // If not vectorcall, revert to normal behavior. 1758 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 1759 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State); 1760 UsedInAlloca |= (I.info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca); 1761 } 1762 } 1763 1764 // If we needed to use inalloca for any argument, do a second pass and rewrite 1765 // all the memory arguments to use inalloca. 1766 if (UsedInAlloca) 1767 rewriteWithInAlloca(FI); 1768 } 1769 1770 void 1771 X86_32ABIInfo::addFieldToArgStruct(SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> &FrameFields, 1772 CharUnits &StackOffset, ABIArgInfo &Info, 1773 QualType Type) const { 1774 // Arguments are always 4-byte-aligned. 1775 CharUnits FieldAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 1776 1777 assert(StackOffset.isMultipleOf(FieldAlign) && "unaligned inalloca struct"); 1778 Info = ABIArgInfo::getInAlloca(FrameFields.size()); 1779 FrameFields.push_back(CGT.ConvertTypeForMem(Type)); 1780 StackOffset += getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Type); 1781 1782 // Insert padding bytes to respect alignment. 1783 CharUnits FieldEnd = StackOffset; 1784 StackOffset = FieldEnd.alignTo(FieldAlign); 1785 if (StackOffset != FieldEnd) { 1786 CharUnits NumBytes = StackOffset - FieldEnd; 1787 llvm::Type *Ty = llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()); 1788 Ty = llvm::ArrayType::get(Ty, NumBytes.getQuantity()); 1789 FrameFields.push_back(Ty); 1790 } 1791 } 1792 1793 static bool isArgInAlloca(const ABIArgInfo &Info) { 1794 // Leave ignored and inreg arguments alone. 1795 switch (Info.getKind()) { 1796 case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca: 1797 return true; 1798 case ABIArgInfo::Indirect: 1799 assert(Info.getIndirectByVal()); 1800 return true; 1801 case ABIArgInfo::Ignore: 1802 return false; 1803 case ABIArgInfo::Direct: 1804 case ABIArgInfo::Extend: 1805 if (Info.getInReg()) 1806 return false; 1807 return true; 1808 case ABIArgInfo::Expand: 1809 case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand: 1810 // These are aggregate types which are never passed in registers when 1811 // inalloca is involved. 1812 return true; 1813 } 1814 llvm_unreachable("invalid enum"); 1815 } 1816 1817 void X86_32ABIInfo::rewriteWithInAlloca(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 1818 assert(IsWin32StructABI && "inalloca only supported on win32"); 1819 1820 // Build a packed struct type for all of the arguments in memory. 1821 SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> FrameFields; 1822 1823 // The stack alignment is always 4. 1824 CharUnits StackAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 1825 1826 CharUnits StackOffset; 1827 CGFunctionInfo::arg_iterator I = FI.arg_begin(), E = FI.arg_end(); 1828 1829 // Put 'this' into the struct before 'sret', if necessary. 1830 bool IsThisCall = 1831 FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_ThisCall; 1832 ABIArgInfo &Ret = FI.getReturnInfo(); 1833 if (Ret.isIndirect() && Ret.isSRetAfterThis() && !IsThisCall && 1834 isArgInAlloca(I->info)) { 1835 addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, I->info, I->type); 1836 ++I; 1837 } 1838 1839 // Put the sret parameter into the inalloca struct if it's in memory. 1840 if (Ret.isIndirect() && !Ret.getInReg()) { 1841 CanQualType PtrTy = getContext().getPointerType(FI.getReturnType()); 1842 addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, Ret, PtrTy); 1843 // On Windows, the hidden sret parameter is always returned in eax. 1844 Ret.setInAllocaSRet(IsWin32StructABI); 1845 } 1846 1847 // Skip the 'this' parameter in ecx. 1848 if (IsThisCall) 1849 ++I; 1850 1851 // Put arguments passed in memory into the struct. 1852 for (; I != E; ++I) { 1853 if (isArgInAlloca(I->info)) 1854 addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, I->info, I->type); 1855 } 1856 1857 FI.setArgStruct(llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), FrameFields, 1858 /*isPacked=*/true), 1859 StackAlign); 1860 } 1861 1862 Address X86_32ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 1863 Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) const { 1864 1865 auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 1866 1867 // x86-32 changes the alignment of certain arguments on the stack. 1868 // 1869 // Just messing with TypeInfo like this works because we never pass 1870 // anything indirectly. 1871 TypeInfo.second = CharUnits::fromQuantity( 1872 getTypeStackAlignInBytes(Ty, TypeInfo.second.getQuantity())); 1873 1874 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false, 1875 TypeInfo, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 1876 /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 1877 } 1878 1879 bool X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI( 1880 const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts) { 1881 assert(Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86); 1882 1883 switch (Opts.getStructReturnConvention()) { 1884 case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_Default: 1885 break; 1886 case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_OnStack: // -fpcc-struct-return 1887 return false; 1888 case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_InRegs: // -freg-struct-return 1889 return true; 1890 } 1891 1892 if (Triple.isOSDarwin() || Triple.isOSIAMCU()) 1893 return true; 1894 1895 switch (Triple.getOS()) { 1896 case llvm::Triple::DragonFly: 1897 case llvm::Triple::FreeBSD: 1898 case llvm::Triple::OpenBSD: 1899 case llvm::Triple::Bitrig: 1900 case llvm::Triple::Win32: 1901 return true; 1902 default: 1903 return false; 1904 } 1905 } 1906 1907 void X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, 1908 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 1909 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 1910 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1911 if (FD->hasAttr<X86ForceAlignArgPointerAttr>()) { 1912 // Get the LLVM function. 1913 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 1914 1915 // Now add the 'alignstack' attribute with a value of 16. 1916 llvm::AttrBuilder B; 1917 B.addStackAlignmentAttr(16); 1918 Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B); 1919 } 1920 if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 1921 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 1922 Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR); 1923 } 1924 } 1925 } 1926 1927 bool X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable( 1928 CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 1929 llvm::Value *Address) const { 1930 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 1931 1932 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4); 1933 1934 // 0-7 are the eight integer registers; the order is different 1935 // on Darwin (for EH), but the range is the same. 1936 // 8 is %eip. 1937 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 8); 1938 1939 if (CGF.CGM.getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) { 1940 // 12-16 are st(0..4). Not sure why we stop at 4. 1941 // These have size 16, which is sizeof(long double) on 1942 // platforms with 8-byte alignment for that type. 1943 llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 16); 1944 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 12, 16); 1945 1946 } else { 1947 // 9 is %eflags, which doesn't get a size on Darwin for some 1948 // reason. 1949 Builder.CreateAlignedStore( 1950 Four8, Builder.CreateConstInBoundsGEP1_32(CGF.Int8Ty, Address, 9), 1951 CharUnits::One()); 1952 1953 // 11-16 are st(0..5). Not sure why we stop at 5. 1954 // These have size 12, which is sizeof(long double) on 1955 // platforms with 4-byte alignment for that type. 1956 llvm::Value *Twelve8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 12); 1957 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Twelve8, 11, 16); 1958 } 1959 1960 return false; 1961 } 1962 1963 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1964 // X86-64 ABI Implementation 1965 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1966 1967 1968 namespace { 1969 /// The AVX ABI level for X86 targets. 1970 enum class X86AVXABILevel { 1971 None, 1972 AVX, 1973 AVX512 1974 }; 1975 1976 /// \p returns the size in bits of the largest (native) vector for \p AVXLevel. 1977 static unsigned getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) { 1978 switch (AVXLevel) { 1979 case X86AVXABILevel::AVX512: 1980 return 512; 1981 case X86AVXABILevel::AVX: 1982 return 256; 1983 case X86AVXABILevel::None: 1984 return 128; 1985 } 1986 llvm_unreachable("Unknown AVXLevel"); 1987 } 1988 1989 /// X86_64ABIInfo - The X86_64 ABI information. 1990 class X86_64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 1991 enum Class { 1992 Integer = 0, 1993 SSE, 1994 SSEUp, 1995 X87, 1996 X87Up, 1997 ComplexX87, 1998 NoClass, 1999 Memory 2000 }; 2001 2002 /// merge - Implement the X86_64 ABI merging algorithm. 2003 /// 2004 /// Merge an accumulating classification \arg Accum with a field 2005 /// classification \arg Field. 2006 /// 2007 /// \param Accum - The accumulating classification. This should 2008 /// always be either NoClass or the result of a previous merge 2009 /// call. In addition, this should never be Memory (the caller 2010 /// should just return Memory for the aggregate). 2011 static Class merge(Class Accum, Class Field); 2012 2013 /// postMerge - Implement the X86_64 ABI post merging algorithm. 2014 /// 2015 /// Post merger cleanup, reduces a malformed Hi and Lo pair to 2016 /// final MEMORY or SSE classes when necessary. 2017 /// 2018 /// \param AggregateSize - The size of the current aggregate in 2019 /// the classification process. 2020 /// 2021 /// \param Lo - The classification for the parts of the type 2022 /// residing in the low word of the containing object. 2023 /// 2024 /// \param Hi - The classification for the parts of the type 2025 /// residing in the higher words of the containing object. 2026 /// 2027 void postMerge(unsigned AggregateSize, Class &Lo, Class &Hi) const; 2028 2029 /// classify - Determine the x86_64 register classes in which the 2030 /// given type T should be passed. 2031 /// 2032 /// \param Lo - The classification for the parts of the type 2033 /// residing in the low word of the containing object. 2034 /// 2035 /// \param Hi - The classification for the parts of the type 2036 /// residing in the high word of the containing object. 2037 /// 2038 /// \param OffsetBase - The bit offset of this type in the 2039 /// containing object. Some parameters are classified different 2040 /// depending on whether they straddle an eightbyte boundary. 2041 /// 2042 /// \param isNamedArg - Whether the argument in question is a "named" 2043 /// argument, as used in AMD64-ABI 3.5.7. 2044 /// 2045 /// If a word is unused its result will be NoClass; if a type should 2046 /// be passed in Memory then at least the classification of \arg Lo 2047 /// will be Memory. 2048 /// 2049 /// The \arg Lo class will be NoClass iff the argument is ignored. 2050 /// 2051 /// If the \arg Lo class is ComplexX87, then the \arg Hi class will 2052 /// also be ComplexX87. 2053 void classify(QualType T, uint64_t OffsetBase, Class &Lo, Class &Hi, 2054 bool isNamedArg) const; 2055 2056 llvm::Type *GetByteVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 2057 llvm::Type *GetSSETypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, 2058 unsigned IROffset, QualType SourceTy, 2059 unsigned SourceOffset) const; 2060 llvm::Type *GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, 2061 unsigned IROffset, QualType SourceTy, 2062 unsigned SourceOffset) const; 2063 2064 /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result 2065 /// such that the argument will be returned in memory. 2066 ABIArgInfo getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty) const; 2067 2068 /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result 2069 /// such that the argument will be passed in memory. 2070 /// 2071 /// \param freeIntRegs - The number of free integer registers remaining 2072 /// available. 2073 ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs) const; 2074 2075 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 2076 2077 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs, 2078 unsigned &neededInt, unsigned &neededSSE, 2079 bool isNamedArg) const; 2080 2081 ABIArgInfo classifyRegCallStructType(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt, 2082 unsigned &NeededSSE) const; 2083 2084 ABIArgInfo classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt, 2085 unsigned &NeededSSE) const; 2086 2087 bool IsIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 2088 2089 /// The 0.98 ABI revision clarified a lot of ambiguities, 2090 /// unfortunately in ways that were not always consistent with 2091 /// certain previous compilers. In particular, platforms which 2092 /// required strict binary compatibility with older versions of GCC 2093 /// may need to exempt themselves. 2094 bool honorsRevision0_98() const { 2095 return !getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin(); 2096 } 2097 2098 /// GCC classifies <1 x long long> as SSE but compatibility with older clang 2099 // compilers require us to classify it as INTEGER. 2100 bool classifyIntegerMMXAsSSE() const { 2101 const llvm::Triple &Triple = getTarget().getTriple(); 2102 if (Triple.isOSDarwin() || Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::PS4) 2103 return false; 2104 if (Triple.isOSFreeBSD() && Triple.getOSMajorVersion() >= 10) 2105 return false; 2106 return true; 2107 } 2108 2109 X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel; 2110 // Some ABIs (e.g. X32 ABI and Native Client OS) use 32 bit pointers on 2111 // 64-bit hardware. 2112 bool Has64BitPointers; 2113 2114 public: 2115 X86_64ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) : 2116 SwiftABIInfo(CGT), AVXLevel(AVXLevel), 2117 Has64BitPointers(CGT.getDataLayout().getPointerSize(0) == 8) { 2118 } 2119 2120 bool isPassedUsingAVXType(QualType type) const { 2121 unsigned neededInt, neededSSE; 2122 // The freeIntRegs argument doesn't matter here. 2123 ABIArgInfo info = classifyArgumentType(type, 0, neededInt, neededSSE, 2124 /*isNamedArg*/true); 2125 if (info.isDirect()) { 2126 llvm::Type *ty = info.getCoerceToType(); 2127 if (llvm::VectorType *vectorTy = dyn_cast_or_null<llvm::VectorType>(ty)) 2128 return (vectorTy->getBitWidth() > 128); 2129 } 2130 return false; 2131 } 2132 2133 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 2134 2135 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 2136 QualType Ty) const override; 2137 Address EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 2138 QualType Ty) const override; 2139 2140 bool has64BitPointers() const { 2141 return Has64BitPointers; 2142 } 2143 2144 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 2145 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 2146 bool asReturnValue) const override { 2147 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 2148 } 2149 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 2150 return true; 2151 } 2152 }; 2153 2154 /// WinX86_64ABIInfo - The Windows X86_64 ABI information. 2155 class WinX86_64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 2156 public: 2157 WinX86_64ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 2158 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), 2159 IsMingw64(getTarget().getTriple().isWindowsGNUEnvironment()) {} 2160 2161 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 2162 2163 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 2164 QualType Ty) const override; 2165 2166 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override { 2167 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 2168 return isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(getContext(), Ty); 2169 } 2170 2171 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 2172 uint64_t NumMembers) const override { 2173 // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use. 2174 return isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(NumMembers); 2175 } 2176 2177 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 2178 ArrayRef<llvm::Type *> scalars, 2179 bool asReturnValue) const override { 2180 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 2181 } 2182 2183 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 2184 return true; 2185 } 2186 2187 private: 2188 ABIArgInfo classify(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, bool IsReturnType, 2189 bool IsVectorCall, bool IsRegCall) const; 2190 ABIArgInfo reclassifyHvaArgType(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, 2191 const ABIArgInfo ¤t) const; 2192 void computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, unsigned FreeSSERegs, 2193 bool IsVectorCall, bool IsRegCall) const; 2194 2195 bool IsMingw64; 2196 }; 2197 2198 class X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 2199 public: 2200 X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) 2201 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new X86_64ABIInfo(CGT, AVXLevel)) {} 2202 2203 const X86_64ABIInfo &getABIInfo() const { 2204 return static_cast<const X86_64ABIInfo&>(TargetCodeGenInfo::getABIInfo()); 2205 } 2206 2207 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2208 return 7; 2209 } 2210 2211 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 2212 llvm::Value *Address) const override { 2213 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 8); 2214 2215 // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers. 2216 // 16 is %rip. 2217 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 16); 2218 return false; 2219 } 2220 2221 llvm::Type* adjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 2222 StringRef Constraint, 2223 llvm::Type* Ty) const override { 2224 return X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CGF, Constraint, Ty); 2225 } 2226 2227 bool isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args, 2228 const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const override { 2229 // The default CC on x86-64 sets %al to the number of SSA 2230 // registers used, and GCC sets this when calling an unprototyped 2231 // function, so we override the default behavior. However, don't do 2232 // that when AVX types are involved: the ABI explicitly states it is 2233 // undefined, and it doesn't work in practice because of how the ABI 2234 // defines varargs anyway. 2235 if (fnType->getCallConv() == CC_C) { 2236 bool HasAVXType = false; 2237 for (CallArgList::const_iterator 2238 it = args.begin(), ie = args.end(); it != ie; ++it) { 2239 if (getABIInfo().isPassedUsingAVXType(it->Ty)) { 2240 HasAVXType = true; 2241 break; 2242 } 2243 } 2244 2245 if (!HasAVXType) 2246 return true; 2247 } 2248 2249 return TargetCodeGenInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic(args, fnType); 2250 } 2251 2252 llvm::Constant * 2253 getUBSanFunctionSignature(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2254 unsigned Sig; 2255 if (getABIInfo().has64BitPointers()) 2256 Sig = (0xeb << 0) | // jmp rel8 2257 (0x0a << 8) | // .+0x0c 2258 ('F' << 16) | 2259 ('T' << 24); 2260 else 2261 Sig = (0xeb << 0) | // jmp rel8 2262 (0x06 << 8) | // .+0x08 2263 ('F' << 16) | 2264 ('T' << 24); 2265 return llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGM.Int32Ty, Sig); 2266 } 2267 2268 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2269 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2270 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2271 if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 2272 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 2273 Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR); 2274 } 2275 } 2276 } 2277 }; 2278 2279 class PS4TargetCodeGenInfo : public X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo { 2280 public: 2281 PS4TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) 2282 : X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, AVXLevel) {} 2283 2284 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 2285 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 2286 Opt = "\01"; 2287 // If the argument contains a space, enclose it in quotes. 2288 if (Lib.find(" ") != StringRef::npos) 2289 Opt += "\"" + Lib.str() + "\""; 2290 else 2291 Opt += Lib; 2292 } 2293 }; 2294 2295 static std::string qualifyWindowsLibrary(llvm::StringRef Lib) { 2296 // If the argument does not end in .lib, automatically add the suffix. 2297 // If the argument contains a space, enclose it in quotes. 2298 // This matches the behavior of MSVC. 2299 bool Quote = (Lib.find(" ") != StringRef::npos); 2300 std::string ArgStr = Quote ? "\"" : ""; 2301 ArgStr += Lib; 2302 if (!Lib.endswith_lower(".lib")) 2303 ArgStr += ".lib"; 2304 ArgStr += Quote ? "\"" : ""; 2305 return ArgStr; 2306 } 2307 2308 class WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo : public X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo { 2309 public: 2310 WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, 2311 bool DarwinVectorABI, bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI, 2312 unsigned NumRegisterParameters) 2313 : X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, DarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, 2314 Win32StructABI, NumRegisterParameters, false) {} 2315 2316 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2317 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 2318 2319 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 2320 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 2321 Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:"; 2322 Opt += qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib); 2323 } 2324 2325 void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, 2326 llvm::StringRef Value, 2327 llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override { 2328 Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\""; 2329 } 2330 }; 2331 2332 static void addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(const Decl *D, 2333 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2334 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) { 2335 if (D && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2336 if (CGM.getCodeGenOpts().StackProbeSize != 4096) { 2337 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 2338 2339 Fn->addFnAttr("stack-probe-size", 2340 llvm::utostr(CGM.getCodeGenOpts().StackProbeSize)); 2341 } 2342 } 2343 } 2344 2345 void WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, 2346 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2347 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 2348 X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 2349 2350 addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(D, GV, CGM); 2351 } 2352 2353 class WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 2354 public: 2355 WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, 2356 X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) 2357 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new WinX86_64ABIInfo(CGT)) {} 2358 2359 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2360 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 2361 2362 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 2363 return 7; 2364 } 2365 2366 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 2367 llvm::Value *Address) const override { 2368 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 8); 2369 2370 // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers. 2371 // 16 is %rip. 2372 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 16); 2373 return false; 2374 } 2375 2376 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 2377 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 2378 Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:"; 2379 Opt += qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib); 2380 } 2381 2382 void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, 2383 llvm::StringRef Value, 2384 llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override { 2385 Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\""; 2386 } 2387 }; 2388 2389 void WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, 2390 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 2391 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 2392 TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 2393 2394 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2395 if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 2396 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 2397 Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR); 2398 } 2399 } 2400 2401 addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(D, GV, CGM); 2402 } 2403 } 2404 2405 void X86_64ABIInfo::postMerge(unsigned AggregateSize, Class &Lo, 2406 Class &Hi) const { 2407 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 5. Then a post merger cleanup is done: 2408 // 2409 // (a) If one of the classes is Memory, the whole argument is passed in 2410 // memory. 2411 // 2412 // (b) If X87UP is not preceded by X87, the whole argument is passed in 2413 // memory. 2414 // 2415 // (c) If the size of the aggregate exceeds two eightbytes and the first 2416 // eightbyte isn't SSE or any other eightbyte isn't SSEUP, the whole 2417 // argument is passed in memory. NOTE: This is necessary to keep the 2418 // ABI working for processors that don't support the __m256 type. 2419 // 2420 // (d) If SSEUP is not preceded by SSE or SSEUP, it is converted to SSE. 2421 // 2422 // Some of these are enforced by the merging logic. Others can arise 2423 // only with unions; for example: 2424 // union { _Complex double; unsigned; } 2425 // 2426 // Note that clauses (b) and (c) were added in 0.98. 2427 // 2428 if (Hi == Memory) 2429 Lo = Memory; 2430 if (Hi == X87Up && Lo != X87 && honorsRevision0_98()) 2431 Lo = Memory; 2432 if (AggregateSize > 128 && (Lo != SSE || Hi != SSEUp)) 2433 Lo = Memory; 2434 if (Hi == SSEUp && Lo != SSE) 2435 Hi = SSE; 2436 } 2437 2438 X86_64ABIInfo::Class X86_64ABIInfo::merge(Class Accum, Class Field) { 2439 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 4. Each field of an object is 2440 // classified recursively so that always two fields are 2441 // considered. The resulting class is calculated according to 2442 // the classes of the fields in the eightbyte: 2443 // 2444 // (a) If both classes are equal, this is the resulting class. 2445 // 2446 // (b) If one of the classes is NO_CLASS, the resulting class is 2447 // the other class. 2448 // 2449 // (c) If one of the classes is MEMORY, the result is the MEMORY 2450 // class. 2451 // 2452 // (d) If one of the classes is INTEGER, the result is the 2453 // INTEGER. 2454 // 2455 // (e) If one of the classes is X87, X87UP, COMPLEX_X87 class, 2456 // MEMORY is used as class. 2457 // 2458 // (f) Otherwise class SSE is used. 2459 2460 // Accum should never be memory (we should have returned) or 2461 // ComplexX87 (because this cannot be passed in a structure). 2462 assert((Accum != Memory && Accum != ComplexX87) && 2463 "Invalid accumulated classification during merge."); 2464 if (Accum == Field || Field == NoClass) 2465 return Accum; 2466 if (Field == Memory) 2467 return Memory; 2468 if (Accum == NoClass) 2469 return Field; 2470 if (Accum == Integer || Field == Integer) 2471 return Integer; 2472 if (Field == X87 || Field == X87Up || Field == ComplexX87 || 2473 Accum == X87 || Accum == X87Up) 2474 return Memory; 2475 return SSE; 2476 } 2477 2478 void X86_64ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty, uint64_t OffsetBase, 2479 Class &Lo, Class &Hi, bool isNamedArg) const { 2480 // FIXME: This code can be simplified by introducing a simple value class for 2481 // Class pairs with appropriate constructor methods for the various 2482 // situations. 2483 2484 // FIXME: Some of the split computations are wrong; unaligned vectors 2485 // shouldn't be passed in registers for example, so there is no chance they 2486 // can straddle an eightbyte. Verify & simplify. 2487 2488 Lo = Hi = NoClass; 2489 2490 Class &Current = OffsetBase < 64 ? Lo : Hi; 2491 Current = Memory; 2492 2493 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 2494 BuiltinType::Kind k = BT->getKind(); 2495 2496 if (k == BuiltinType::Void) { 2497 Current = NoClass; 2498 } else if (k == BuiltinType::Int128 || k == BuiltinType::UInt128) { 2499 Lo = Integer; 2500 Hi = Integer; 2501 } else if (k >= BuiltinType::Bool && k <= BuiltinType::LongLong) { 2502 Current = Integer; 2503 } else if (k == BuiltinType::Float || k == BuiltinType::Double) { 2504 Current = SSE; 2505 } else if (k == BuiltinType::LongDouble) { 2506 const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat(); 2507 if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad()) { 2508 Lo = SSE; 2509 Hi = SSEUp; 2510 } else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended()) { 2511 Lo = X87; 2512 Hi = X87Up; 2513 } else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble()) { 2514 Current = SSE; 2515 } else 2516 llvm_unreachable("unexpected long double representation!"); 2517 } 2518 // FIXME: _Decimal32 and _Decimal64 are SSE. 2519 // FIXME: _float128 and _Decimal128 are (SSE, SSEUp). 2520 return; 2521 } 2522 2523 if (const EnumType *ET = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) { 2524 // Classify the underlying integer type. 2525 classify(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(), OffsetBase, Lo, Hi, isNamedArg); 2526 return; 2527 } 2528 2529 if (Ty->hasPointerRepresentation()) { 2530 Current = Integer; 2531 return; 2532 } 2533 2534 if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 2535 if (Ty->isMemberFunctionPointerType()) { 2536 if (Has64BitPointers) { 2537 // If Has64BitPointers, this is an {i64, i64}, so classify both 2538 // Lo and Hi now. 2539 Lo = Hi = Integer; 2540 } else { 2541 // Otherwise, with 32-bit pointers, this is an {i32, i32}. If that 2542 // straddles an eightbyte boundary, Hi should be classified as well. 2543 uint64_t EB_FuncPtr = (OffsetBase) / 64; 2544 uint64_t EB_ThisAdj = (OffsetBase + 64 - 1) / 64; 2545 if (EB_FuncPtr != EB_ThisAdj) { 2546 Lo = Hi = Integer; 2547 } else { 2548 Current = Integer; 2549 } 2550 } 2551 } else { 2552 Current = Integer; 2553 } 2554 return; 2555 } 2556 2557 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 2558 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 2559 if (Size == 1 || Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) { 2560 // gcc passes the following as integer: 2561 // 4 bytes - <4 x char>, <2 x short>, <1 x int>, <1 x float> 2562 // 2 bytes - <2 x char>, <1 x short> 2563 // 1 byte - <1 x char> 2564 Current = Integer; 2565 2566 // If this type crosses an eightbyte boundary, it should be 2567 // split. 2568 uint64_t EB_Lo = (OffsetBase) / 64; 2569 uint64_t EB_Hi = (OffsetBase + Size - 1) / 64; 2570 if (EB_Lo != EB_Hi) 2571 Hi = Lo; 2572 } else if (Size == 64) { 2573 QualType ElementType = VT->getElementType(); 2574 2575 // gcc passes <1 x double> in memory. :( 2576 if (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double)) 2577 return; 2578 2579 // gcc passes <1 x long long> as SSE but clang used to unconditionally 2580 // pass them as integer. For platforms where clang is the de facto 2581 // platform compiler, we must continue to use integer. 2582 if (!classifyIntegerMMXAsSSE() && 2583 (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) || 2584 ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong) || 2585 ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Long) || 2586 ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULong))) 2587 Current = Integer; 2588 else 2589 Current = SSE; 2590 2591 // If this type crosses an eightbyte boundary, it should be 2592 // split. 2593 if (OffsetBase && OffsetBase != 64) 2594 Hi = Lo; 2595 } else if (Size == 128 || 2596 (isNamedArg && Size <= getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) { 2597 // Arguments of 256-bits are split into four eightbyte chunks. The 2598 // least significant one belongs to class SSE and all the others to class 2599 // SSEUP. The original Lo and Hi design considers that types can't be 2600 // greater than 128-bits, so a 64-bit split in Hi and Lo makes sense. 2601 // This design isn't correct for 256-bits, but since there're no cases 2602 // where the upper parts would need to be inspected, avoid adding 2603 // complexity and just consider Hi to match the 64-256 part. 2604 // 2605 // Note that per 3.5.7 of AMD64-ABI, 256-bit args are only passed in 2606 // registers if they are "named", i.e. not part of the "..." of a 2607 // variadic function. 2608 // 2609 // Similarly, per 3.2.3. of the AVX512 draft, 512-bits ("named") args are 2610 // split into eight eightbyte chunks, one SSE and seven SSEUP. 2611 Lo = SSE; 2612 Hi = SSEUp; 2613 } 2614 return; 2615 } 2616 2617 if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 2618 QualType ET = getContext().getCanonicalType(CT->getElementType()); 2619 2620 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2621 if (ET->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 2622 if (Size <= 64) 2623 Current = Integer; 2624 else if (Size <= 128) 2625 Lo = Hi = Integer; 2626 } else if (ET == getContext().FloatTy) { 2627 Current = SSE; 2628 } else if (ET == getContext().DoubleTy) { 2629 Lo = Hi = SSE; 2630 } else if (ET == getContext().LongDoubleTy) { 2631 const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat(); 2632 if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad()) 2633 Current = Memory; 2634 else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended()) 2635 Current = ComplexX87; 2636 else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble()) 2637 Lo = Hi = SSE; 2638 else 2639 llvm_unreachable("unexpected long double representation!"); 2640 } 2641 2642 // If this complex type crosses an eightbyte boundary then it 2643 // should be split. 2644 uint64_t EB_Real = (OffsetBase) / 64; 2645 uint64_t EB_Imag = (OffsetBase + getContext().getTypeSize(ET)) / 64; 2646 if (Hi == NoClass && EB_Real != EB_Imag) 2647 Hi = Lo; 2648 2649 return; 2650 } 2651 2652 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) { 2653 // Arrays are treated like structures. 2654 2655 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2656 2657 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger 2658 // than eight eightbytes, ..., it has class MEMORY. 2659 if (Size > 512) 2660 return; 2661 2662 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If ..., or it contains unaligned 2663 // fields, it has class MEMORY. 2664 // 2665 // Only need to check alignment of array base. 2666 if (OffsetBase % getContext().getTypeAlign(AT->getElementType())) 2667 return; 2668 2669 // Otherwise implement simplified merge. We could be smarter about 2670 // this, but it isn't worth it and would be harder to verify. 2671 Current = NoClass; 2672 uint64_t EltSize = getContext().getTypeSize(AT->getElementType()); 2673 uint64_t ArraySize = AT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 2674 2675 // The only case a 256-bit wide vector could be used is when the array 2676 // contains a single 256-bit element. Since Lo and Hi logic isn't extended 2677 // to work for sizes wider than 128, early check and fallback to memory. 2678 // 2679 if (Size > 128 && 2680 (Size != EltSize || Size > getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) 2681 return; 2682 2683 for (uint64_t i=0, Offset=OffsetBase; i<ArraySize; ++i, Offset += EltSize) { 2684 Class FieldLo, FieldHi; 2685 classify(AT->getElementType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg); 2686 Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo); 2687 Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi); 2688 if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) 2689 break; 2690 } 2691 2692 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2693 assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp array classification."); 2694 return; 2695 } 2696 2697 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 2698 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2699 2700 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger 2701 // than eight eightbytes, ..., it has class MEMORY. 2702 if (Size > 512) 2703 return; 2704 2705 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 2. If a C++ object has either a non-trivial 2706 // copy constructor or a non-trivial destructor, it is passed by invisible 2707 // reference. 2708 if (getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI())) 2709 return; 2710 2711 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 2712 2713 // Assume variable sized types are passed in memory. 2714 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 2715 return; 2716 2717 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD); 2718 2719 // Reset Lo class, this will be recomputed. 2720 Current = NoClass; 2721 2722 // If this is a C++ record, classify the bases first. 2723 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 2724 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 2725 assert(!I.isVirtual() && !I.getType()->isDependentType() && 2726 "Unexpected base class!"); 2727 const CXXRecordDecl *Base = 2728 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(I.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 2729 2730 // Classify this field. 2731 // 2732 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 3. If the size of the aggregate exceeds a 2733 // single eightbyte, each is classified separately. Each eightbyte gets 2734 // initialized to class NO_CLASS. 2735 Class FieldLo, FieldHi; 2736 uint64_t Offset = 2737 OffsetBase + getContext().toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base)); 2738 classify(I.getType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg); 2739 Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo); 2740 Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi); 2741 if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) { 2742 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2743 return; 2744 } 2745 } 2746 } 2747 2748 // Classify the fields one at a time, merging the results. 2749 unsigned idx = 0; 2750 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 2751 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 2752 uint64_t Offset = OffsetBase + Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 2753 bool BitField = i->isBitField(); 2754 2755 // Ignore padding bit-fields. 2756 if (BitField && i->isUnnamedBitfield()) 2757 continue; 2758 2759 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger than 2760 // four eightbytes, or it contains unaligned fields, it has class MEMORY. 2761 // 2762 // The only case a 256-bit wide vector could be used is when the struct 2763 // contains a single 256-bit element. Since Lo and Hi logic isn't extended 2764 // to work for sizes wider than 128, early check and fallback to memory. 2765 // 2766 if (Size > 128 && (Size != getContext().getTypeSize(i->getType()) || 2767 Size > getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) { 2768 Lo = Memory; 2769 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2770 return; 2771 } 2772 // Note, skip this test for bit-fields, see below. 2773 if (!BitField && Offset % getContext().getTypeAlign(i->getType())) { 2774 Lo = Memory; 2775 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2776 return; 2777 } 2778 2779 // Classify this field. 2780 // 2781 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 3. If the size of the aggregate 2782 // exceeds a single eightbyte, each is classified 2783 // separately. Each eightbyte gets initialized to class 2784 // NO_CLASS. 2785 Class FieldLo, FieldHi; 2786 2787 // Bit-fields require special handling, they do not force the 2788 // structure to be passed in memory even if unaligned, and 2789 // therefore they can straddle an eightbyte. 2790 if (BitField) { 2791 assert(!i->isUnnamedBitfield()); 2792 uint64_t Offset = OffsetBase + Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 2793 uint64_t Size = i->getBitWidthValue(getContext()); 2794 2795 uint64_t EB_Lo = Offset / 64; 2796 uint64_t EB_Hi = (Offset + Size - 1) / 64; 2797 2798 if (EB_Lo) { 2799 assert(EB_Hi == EB_Lo && "Invalid classification, type > 16 bytes."); 2800 FieldLo = NoClass; 2801 FieldHi = Integer; 2802 } else { 2803 FieldLo = Integer; 2804 FieldHi = EB_Hi ? Integer : NoClass; 2805 } 2806 } else 2807 classify(i->getType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg); 2808 Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo); 2809 Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi); 2810 if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) 2811 break; 2812 } 2813 2814 postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi); 2815 } 2816 } 2817 2818 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty) const { 2819 // If this is a scalar LLVM value then assume LLVM will pass it in the right 2820 // place naturally. 2821 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 2822 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 2823 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 2824 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2825 2826 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 2827 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 2828 } 2829 2830 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty); 2831 } 2832 2833 bool X86_64ABIInfo::IsIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 2834 if (const VectorType *VecTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 2835 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VecTy); 2836 unsigned LargestVector = getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel); 2837 if (Size <= 64 || Size > LargestVector) 2838 return true; 2839 } 2840 2841 return false; 2842 } 2843 2844 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, 2845 unsigned freeIntRegs) const { 2846 // If this is a scalar LLVM value then assume LLVM will pass it in the right 2847 // place naturally. 2848 // 2849 // This assumption is optimistic, as there could be free registers available 2850 // when we need to pass this argument in memory, and LLVM could try to pass 2851 // the argument in the free register. This does not seem to happen currently, 2852 // but this code would be much safer if we could mark the argument with 2853 // 'onstack'. See PR12193. 2854 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !IsIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 2855 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 2856 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 2857 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2858 2859 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 2860 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 2861 } 2862 2863 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 2864 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 2865 2866 // Compute the byval alignment. We specify the alignment of the byval in all 2867 // cases so that the mid-level optimizer knows the alignment of the byval. 2868 unsigned Align = std::max(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8, 8U); 2869 2870 // Attempt to avoid passing indirect results using byval when possible. This 2871 // is important for good codegen. 2872 // 2873 // We do this by coercing the value into a scalar type which the backend can 2874 // handle naturally (i.e., without using byval). 2875 // 2876 // For simplicity, we currently only do this when we have exhausted all of the 2877 // free integer registers. Doing this when there are free integer registers 2878 // would require more care, as we would have to ensure that the coerced value 2879 // did not claim the unused register. That would require either reording the 2880 // arguments to the function (so that any subsequent inreg values came first), 2881 // or only doing this optimization when there were no following arguments that 2882 // might be inreg. 2883 // 2884 // We currently expect it to be rare (particularly in well written code) for 2885 // arguments to be passed on the stack when there are still free integer 2886 // registers available (this would typically imply large structs being passed 2887 // by value), so this seems like a fair tradeoff for now. 2888 // 2889 // We can revisit this if the backend grows support for 'onstack' parameter 2890 // attributes. See PR12193. 2891 if (freeIntRegs == 0) { 2892 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2893 2894 // If this type fits in an eightbyte, coerce it into the matching integral 2895 // type, which will end up on the stack (with alignment 8). 2896 if (Align == 8 && Size <= 64) 2897 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 2898 Size)); 2899 } 2900 2901 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align)); 2902 } 2903 2904 /// The ABI specifies that a value should be passed in a full vector XMM/YMM 2905 /// register. Pick an LLVM IR type that will be passed as a vector register. 2906 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo::GetByteVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 2907 // Wrapper structs/arrays that only contain vectors are passed just like 2908 // vectors; strip them off if present. 2909 if (const Type *InnerTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext())) 2910 Ty = QualType(InnerTy, 0); 2911 2912 llvm::Type *IRType = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 2913 if (isa<llvm::VectorType>(IRType) || 2914 IRType->getTypeID() == llvm::Type::FP128TyID) 2915 return IRType; 2916 2917 // We couldn't find the preferred IR vector type for 'Ty'. 2918 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 2919 assert((Size == 128 || Size == 256 || Size == 512) && "Invalid type found!"); 2920 2921 // Return a LLVM IR vector type based on the size of 'Ty'. 2922 return llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()), 2923 Size / 64); 2924 } 2925 2926 /// BitsContainNoUserData - Return true if the specified [start,end) bit range 2927 /// is known to either be off the end of the specified type or being in 2928 /// alignment padding. The user type specified is known to be at most 128 bits 2929 /// in size, and have passed through X86_64ABIInfo::classify with a successful 2930 /// classification that put one of the two halves in the INTEGER class. 2931 /// 2932 /// It is conservatively correct to return false. 2933 static bool BitsContainNoUserData(QualType Ty, unsigned StartBit, 2934 unsigned EndBit, ASTContext &Context) { 2935 // If the bytes being queried are off the end of the type, there is no user 2936 // data hiding here. This handles analysis of builtins, vectors and other 2937 // types that don't contain interesting padding. 2938 unsigned TySize = (unsigned)Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 2939 if (TySize <= StartBit) 2940 return true; 2941 2942 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) { 2943 unsigned EltSize = (unsigned)Context.getTypeSize(AT->getElementType()); 2944 unsigned NumElts = (unsigned)AT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 2945 2946 // Check each element to see if the element overlaps with the queried range. 2947 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) { 2948 // If the element is after the span we care about, then we're done.. 2949 unsigned EltOffset = i*EltSize; 2950 if (EltOffset >= EndBit) break; 2951 2952 unsigned EltStart = EltOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-EltOffset :0; 2953 if (!BitsContainNoUserData(AT->getElementType(), EltStart, 2954 EndBit-EltOffset, Context)) 2955 return false; 2956 } 2957 // If it overlaps no elements, then it is safe to process as padding. 2958 return true; 2959 } 2960 2961 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 2962 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 2963 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD); 2964 2965 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 2966 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 2967 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 2968 assert(!I.isVirtual() && !I.getType()->isDependentType() && 2969 "Unexpected base class!"); 2970 const CXXRecordDecl *Base = 2971 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(I.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 2972 2973 // If the base is after the span we care about, ignore it. 2974 unsigned BaseOffset = Context.toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base)); 2975 if (BaseOffset >= EndBit) continue; 2976 2977 unsigned BaseStart = BaseOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-BaseOffset :0; 2978 if (!BitsContainNoUserData(I.getType(), BaseStart, 2979 EndBit-BaseOffset, Context)) 2980 return false; 2981 } 2982 } 2983 2984 // Verify that no field has data that overlaps the region of interest. Yes 2985 // this could be sped up a lot by being smarter about queried fields, 2986 // however we're only looking at structs up to 16 bytes, so we don't care 2987 // much. 2988 unsigned idx = 0; 2989 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 2990 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 2991 unsigned FieldOffset = (unsigned)Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 2992 2993 // If we found a field after the region we care about, then we're done. 2994 if (FieldOffset >= EndBit) break; 2995 2996 unsigned FieldStart = FieldOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-FieldOffset :0; 2997 if (!BitsContainNoUserData(i->getType(), FieldStart, EndBit-FieldOffset, 2998 Context)) 2999 return false; 3000 } 3001 3002 // If nothing in this record overlapped the area of interest, then we're 3003 // clean. 3004 return true; 3005 } 3006 3007 return false; 3008 } 3009 3010 /// ContainsFloatAtOffset - Return true if the specified LLVM IR type has a 3011 /// float member at the specified offset. For example, {int,{float}} has a 3012 /// float at offset 4. It is conservatively correct for this routine to return 3013 /// false. 3014 static bool ContainsFloatAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset, 3015 const llvm::DataLayout &TD) { 3016 // Base case if we find a float. 3017 if (IROffset == 0 && IRType->isFloatTy()) 3018 return true; 3019 3020 // If this is a struct, recurse into the field at the specified offset. 3021 if (llvm::StructType *STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(IRType)) { 3022 const llvm::StructLayout *SL = TD.getStructLayout(STy); 3023 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(IROffset); 3024 IROffset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt); 3025 return ContainsFloatAtOffset(STy->getElementType(Elt), IROffset, TD); 3026 } 3027 3028 // If this is an array, recurse into the field at the specified offset. 3029 if (llvm::ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(IRType)) { 3030 llvm::Type *EltTy = ATy->getElementType(); 3031 unsigned EltSize = TD.getTypeAllocSize(EltTy); 3032 IROffset -= IROffset/EltSize*EltSize; 3033 return ContainsFloatAtOffset(EltTy, IROffset, TD); 3034 } 3035 3036 return false; 3037 } 3038 3039 3040 /// GetSSETypeAtOffset - Return a type that will be passed by the backend in the 3041 /// low 8 bytes of an XMM register, corresponding to the SSE class. 3042 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo:: 3043 GetSSETypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset, 3044 QualType SourceTy, unsigned SourceOffset) const { 3045 // The only three choices we have are either double, <2 x float>, or float. We 3046 // pass as float if the last 4 bytes is just padding. This happens for 3047 // structs that contain 3 floats. 3048 if (BitsContainNoUserData(SourceTy, SourceOffset*8+32, 3049 SourceOffset*8+64, getContext())) 3050 return llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()); 3051 3052 // We want to pass as <2 x float> if the LLVM IR type contains a float at 3053 // offset+0 and offset+4. Walk the LLVM IR type to find out if this is the 3054 // case. 3055 if (ContainsFloatAtOffset(IRType, IROffset, getDataLayout()) && 3056 ContainsFloatAtOffset(IRType, IROffset+4, getDataLayout())) 3057 return llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()), 2); 3058 3059 return llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()); 3060 } 3061 3062 3063 /// GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset - The ABI specifies that a value should be passed in 3064 /// an 8-byte GPR. This means that we either have a scalar or we are talking 3065 /// about the high or low part of an up-to-16-byte struct. This routine picks 3066 /// the best LLVM IR type to represent this, which may be i64 or may be anything 3067 /// else that the backend will pass in a GPR that works better (e.g. i8, %foo*, 3068 /// etc). 3069 /// 3070 /// PrefType is an LLVM IR type that corresponds to (part of) the IR type for 3071 /// the source type. IROffset is an offset in bytes into the LLVM IR type that 3072 /// the 8-byte value references. PrefType may be null. 3073 /// 3074 /// SourceTy is the source-level type for the entire argument. SourceOffset is 3075 /// an offset into this that we're processing (which is always either 0 or 8). 3076 /// 3077 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo:: 3078 GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset, 3079 QualType SourceTy, unsigned SourceOffset) const { 3080 // If we're dealing with an un-offset LLVM IR type, then it means that we're 3081 // returning an 8-byte unit starting with it. See if we can safely use it. 3082 if (IROffset == 0) { 3083 // Pointers and int64's always fill the 8-byte unit. 3084 if ((isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) && Has64BitPointers) || 3085 IRType->isIntegerTy(64)) 3086 return IRType; 3087 3088 // If we have a 1/2/4-byte integer, we can use it only if the rest of the 3089 // goodness in the source type is just tail padding. This is allowed to 3090 // kick in for struct {double,int} on the int, but not on 3091 // struct{double,int,int} because we wouldn't return the second int. We 3092 // have to do this analysis on the source type because we can't depend on 3093 // unions being lowered a specific way etc. 3094 if (IRType->isIntegerTy(8) || IRType->isIntegerTy(16) || 3095 IRType->isIntegerTy(32) || 3096 (isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) && !Has64BitPointers)) { 3097 unsigned BitWidth = isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) ? 32 : 3098 cast<llvm::IntegerType>(IRType)->getBitWidth(); 3099 3100 if (BitsContainNoUserData(SourceTy, SourceOffset*8+BitWidth, 3101 SourceOffset*8+64, getContext())) 3102 return IRType; 3103 } 3104 } 3105 3106 if (llvm::StructType *STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(IRType)) { 3107 // If this is a struct, recurse into the field at the specified offset. 3108 const llvm::StructLayout *SL = getDataLayout().getStructLayout(STy); 3109 if (IROffset < SL->getSizeInBytes()) { 3110 unsigned FieldIdx = SL->getElementContainingOffset(IROffset); 3111 IROffset -= SL->getElementOffset(FieldIdx); 3112 3113 return GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(STy->getElementType(FieldIdx), IROffset, 3114 SourceTy, SourceOffset); 3115 } 3116 } 3117 3118 if (llvm::ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(IRType)) { 3119 llvm::Type *EltTy = ATy->getElementType(); 3120 unsigned EltSize = getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(EltTy); 3121 unsigned EltOffset = IROffset/EltSize*EltSize; 3122 return GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(EltTy, IROffset-EltOffset, SourceTy, 3123 SourceOffset); 3124 } 3125 3126 // Okay, we don't have any better idea of what to pass, so we pass this in an 3127 // integer register that isn't too big to fit the rest of the struct. 3128 unsigned TySizeInBytes = 3129 (unsigned)getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(SourceTy).getQuantity(); 3130 3131 assert(TySizeInBytes != SourceOffset && "Empty field?"); 3132 3133 // It is always safe to classify this as an integer type up to i64 that 3134 // isn't larger than the structure. 3135 return llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 3136 std::min(TySizeInBytes-SourceOffset, 8U)*8); 3137 } 3138 3139 3140 /// GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair - Given a high and low type that can ideally 3141 /// be used as elements of a two register pair to pass or return, return a 3142 /// first class aggregate to represent them. For example, if the low part of 3143 /// a by-value argument should be passed as i32* and the high part as float, 3144 /// return {i32*, float}. 3145 static llvm::Type * 3146 GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(llvm::Type *Lo, llvm::Type *Hi, 3147 const llvm::DataLayout &TD) { 3148 // In order to correctly satisfy the ABI, we need to the high part to start 3149 // at offset 8. If the high and low parts we inferred are both 4-byte types 3150 // (e.g. i32 and i32) then the resultant struct type ({i32,i32}) won't have 3151 // the second element at offset 8. Check for this: 3152 unsigned LoSize = (unsigned)TD.getTypeAllocSize(Lo); 3153 unsigned HiAlign = TD.getABITypeAlignment(Hi); 3154 unsigned HiStart = llvm::alignTo(LoSize, HiAlign); 3155 assert(HiStart != 0 && HiStart <= 8 && "Invalid x86-64 argument pair!"); 3156 3157 // To handle this, we have to increase the size of the low part so that the 3158 // second element will start at an 8 byte offset. We can't increase the size 3159 // of the second element because it might make us access off the end of the 3160 // struct. 3161 if (HiStart != 8) { 3162 // There are usually two sorts of types the ABI generation code can produce 3163 // for the low part of a pair that aren't 8 bytes in size: float or 3164 // i8/i16/i32. This can also include pointers when they are 32-bit (X32 and 3165 // NaCl). 3166 // Promote these to a larger type. 3167 if (Lo->isFloatTy()) 3168 Lo = llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(Lo->getContext()); 3169 else { 3170 assert((Lo->isIntegerTy() || Lo->isPointerTy()) 3171 && "Invalid/unknown lo type"); 3172 Lo = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(Lo->getContext()); 3173 } 3174 } 3175 3176 llvm::StructType *Result = llvm::StructType::get(Lo, Hi); 3177 3178 // Verify that the second element is at an 8-byte offset. 3179 assert(TD.getStructLayout(Result)->getElementOffset(1) == 8 && 3180 "Invalid x86-64 argument pair!"); 3181 return Result; 3182 } 3183 3184 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo:: 3185 classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 3186 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 1. Classify the return type with the 3187 // classification algorithm. 3188 X86_64ABIInfo::Class Lo, Hi; 3189 classify(RetTy, 0, Lo, Hi, /*isNamedArg*/ true); 3190 3191 // Check some invariants. 3192 assert((Hi != Memory || Lo == Memory) && "Invalid memory classification."); 3193 assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp classification."); 3194 3195 llvm::Type *ResType = nullptr; 3196 switch (Lo) { 3197 case NoClass: 3198 if (Hi == NoClass) 3199 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 3200 // If the low part is just padding, it takes no register, leave ResType 3201 // null. 3202 assert((Hi == SSE || Hi == Integer || Hi == X87Up) && 3203 "Unknown missing lo part"); 3204 break; 3205 3206 case SSEUp: 3207 case X87Up: 3208 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for lo word."); 3209 3210 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 2. Types of class memory are returned via 3211 // hidden argument. 3212 case Memory: 3213 return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy); 3214 3215 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 3. If the class is INTEGER, the next 3216 // available register of the sequence %rax, %rdx is used. 3217 case Integer: 3218 ResType = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 0, RetTy, 0); 3219 3220 // If we have a sign or zero extended integer, make sure to return Extend 3221 // so that the parameter gets the right LLVM IR attributes. 3222 if (Hi == NoClass && isa<llvm::IntegerType>(ResType)) { 3223 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 3224 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 3225 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 3226 3227 if (RetTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 3228 RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) 3229 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 3230 } 3231 break; 3232 3233 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 4. If the class is SSE, the next 3234 // available SSE register of the sequence %xmm0, %xmm1 is used. 3235 case SSE: 3236 ResType = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 0, RetTy, 0); 3237 break; 3238 3239 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 6. If the class is X87, the value is 3240 // returned on the X87 stack in %st0 as 80-bit x87 number. 3241 case X87: 3242 ResType = llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()); 3243 break; 3244 3245 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 8. If the class is COMPLEX_X87, the real 3246 // part of the value is returned in %st0 and the imaginary part in 3247 // %st1. 3248 case ComplexX87: 3249 assert(Hi == ComplexX87 && "Unexpected ComplexX87 classification."); 3250 ResType = llvm::StructType::get(llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()), 3251 llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext())); 3252 break; 3253 } 3254 3255 llvm::Type *HighPart = nullptr; 3256 switch (Hi) { 3257 // Memory was handled previously and X87 should 3258 // never occur as a hi class. 3259 case Memory: 3260 case X87: 3261 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for hi word."); 3262 3263 case ComplexX87: // Previously handled. 3264 case NoClass: 3265 break; 3266 3267 case Integer: 3268 HighPart = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8); 3269 if (Lo == NoClass) // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3270 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3271 break; 3272 case SSE: 3273 HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8); 3274 if (Lo == NoClass) // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3275 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3276 break; 3277 3278 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 5. If the class is SSEUP, the eightbyte 3279 // is passed in the next available eightbyte chunk if the last used 3280 // vector register. 3281 // 3282 // SSEUP should always be preceded by SSE, just widen. 3283 case SSEUp: 3284 assert(Lo == SSE && "Unexpected SSEUp classification."); 3285 ResType = GetByteVectorType(RetTy); 3286 break; 3287 3288 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 7. If the class is X87UP, the value is 3289 // returned together with the previous X87 value in %st0. 3290 case X87Up: 3291 // If X87Up is preceded by X87, we don't need to do 3292 // anything. However, in some cases with unions it may not be 3293 // preceded by X87. In such situations we follow gcc and pass the 3294 // extra bits in an SSE reg. 3295 if (Lo != X87) { 3296 HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8); 3297 if (Lo == NoClass) // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3298 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3299 } 3300 break; 3301 } 3302 3303 // If a high part was specified, merge it together with the low part. It is 3304 // known to pass in the high eightbyte of the result. We do this by forming a 3305 // first class struct aggregate with the high and low part: {low, high} 3306 if (HighPart) 3307 ResType = GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(ResType, HighPart, getDataLayout()); 3308 3309 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 3310 } 3311 3312 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType( 3313 QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs, unsigned &neededInt, unsigned &neededSSE, 3314 bool isNamedArg) 3315 const 3316 { 3317 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 3318 3319 X86_64ABIInfo::Class Lo, Hi; 3320 classify(Ty, 0, Lo, Hi, isNamedArg); 3321 3322 // Check some invariants. 3323 // FIXME: Enforce these by construction. 3324 assert((Hi != Memory || Lo == Memory) && "Invalid memory classification."); 3325 assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp classification."); 3326 3327 neededInt = 0; 3328 neededSSE = 0; 3329 llvm::Type *ResType = nullptr; 3330 switch (Lo) { 3331 case NoClass: 3332 if (Hi == NoClass) 3333 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 3334 // If the low part is just padding, it takes no register, leave ResType 3335 // null. 3336 assert((Hi == SSE || Hi == Integer || Hi == X87Up) && 3337 "Unknown missing lo part"); 3338 break; 3339 3340 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 1. If the class is MEMORY, pass the argument 3341 // on the stack. 3342 case Memory: 3343 3344 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 5. If the class is X87, X87UP or 3345 // COMPLEX_X87, it is passed in memory. 3346 case X87: 3347 case ComplexX87: 3348 if (getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()) == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) 3349 ++neededInt; 3350 return getIndirectResult(Ty, freeIntRegs); 3351 3352 case SSEUp: 3353 case X87Up: 3354 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for lo word."); 3355 3356 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 2. If the class is INTEGER, the next 3357 // available register of the sequence %rdi, %rsi, %rdx, %rcx, %r8 3358 // and %r9 is used. 3359 case Integer: 3360 ++neededInt; 3361 3362 // Pick an 8-byte type based on the preferred type. 3363 ResType = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 0, Ty, 0); 3364 3365 // If we have a sign or zero extended integer, make sure to return Extend 3366 // so that the parameter gets the right LLVM IR attributes. 3367 if (Hi == NoClass && isa<llvm::IntegerType>(ResType)) { 3368 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 3369 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 3370 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 3371 3372 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 3373 Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) 3374 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 3375 } 3376 3377 break; 3378 3379 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 3. If the class is SSE, the next 3380 // available SSE register is used, the registers are taken in the 3381 // order from %xmm0 to %xmm7. 3382 case SSE: { 3383 llvm::Type *IRType = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 3384 ResType = GetSSETypeAtOffset(IRType, 0, Ty, 0); 3385 ++neededSSE; 3386 break; 3387 } 3388 } 3389 3390 llvm::Type *HighPart = nullptr; 3391 switch (Hi) { 3392 // Memory was handled previously, ComplexX87 and X87 should 3393 // never occur as hi classes, and X87Up must be preceded by X87, 3394 // which is passed in memory. 3395 case Memory: 3396 case X87: 3397 case ComplexX87: 3398 llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for hi word."); 3399 3400 case NoClass: break; 3401 3402 case Integer: 3403 ++neededInt; 3404 // Pick an 8-byte type based on the preferred type. 3405 HighPart = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 8, Ty, 8); 3406 3407 if (Lo == NoClass) // Pass HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3408 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3409 break; 3410 3411 // X87Up generally doesn't occur here (long double is passed in 3412 // memory), except in situations involving unions. 3413 case X87Up: 3414 case SSE: 3415 HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 8, Ty, 8); 3416 3417 if (Lo == NoClass) // Pass HighPart at offset 8 in memory. 3418 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8); 3419 3420 ++neededSSE; 3421 break; 3422 3423 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 4. If the class is SSEUP, the 3424 // eightbyte is passed in the upper half of the last used SSE 3425 // register. This only happens when 128-bit vectors are passed. 3426 case SSEUp: 3427 assert(Lo == SSE && "Unexpected SSEUp classification"); 3428 ResType = GetByteVectorType(Ty); 3429 break; 3430 } 3431 3432 // If a high part was specified, merge it together with the low part. It is 3433 // known to pass in the high eightbyte of the result. We do this by forming a 3434 // first class struct aggregate with the high and low part: {low, high} 3435 if (HighPart) 3436 ResType = GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(ResType, HighPart, getDataLayout()); 3437 3438 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 3439 } 3440 3441 ABIArgInfo 3442 X86_64ABIInfo::classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt, 3443 unsigned &NeededSSE) const { 3444 auto RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 3445 assert(RT && "classifyRegCallStructType only valid with struct types"); 3446 3447 if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 3448 return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty); 3449 3450 // Sum up bases 3451 if (auto CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl())) { 3452 if (CXXRD->isDynamicClass()) { 3453 NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0; 3454 return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty); 3455 } 3456 3457 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) 3458 if (classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(I.getType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE) 3459 .isIndirect()) { 3460 NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0; 3461 return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty); 3462 } 3463 } 3464 3465 // Sum up members 3466 for (const auto *FD : RT->getDecl()->fields()) { 3467 if (FD->getType()->isRecordType() && !FD->getType()->isUnionType()) { 3468 if (classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(FD->getType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE) 3469 .isIndirect()) { 3470 NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0; 3471 return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty); 3472 } 3473 } else { 3474 unsigned LocalNeededInt, LocalNeededSSE; 3475 if (classifyArgumentType(FD->getType(), UINT_MAX, LocalNeededInt, 3476 LocalNeededSSE, true) 3477 .isIndirect()) { 3478 NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0; 3479 return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty); 3480 } 3481 NeededInt += LocalNeededInt; 3482 NeededSSE += LocalNeededSSE; 3483 } 3484 } 3485 3486 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3487 } 3488 3489 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::classifyRegCallStructType(QualType Ty, 3490 unsigned &NeededInt, 3491 unsigned &NeededSSE) const { 3492 3493 NeededInt = 0; 3494 NeededSSE = 0; 3495 3496 return classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(Ty, NeededInt, NeededSSE); 3497 } 3498 3499 void X86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 3500 3501 bool IsRegCall = FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall; 3502 3503 // Keep track of the number of assigned registers. 3504 unsigned FreeIntRegs = IsRegCall ? 11 : 6; 3505 unsigned FreeSSERegs = IsRegCall ? 16 : 8; 3506 unsigned NeededInt, NeededSSE; 3507 3508 if (IsRegCall && FI.getReturnType()->getTypePtr()->isRecordType() && 3509 !FI.getReturnType()->getTypePtr()->isUnionType()) { 3510 FI.getReturnInfo() = 3511 classifyRegCallStructType(FI.getReturnType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE); 3512 if (FreeIntRegs >= NeededInt && FreeSSERegs >= NeededSSE) { 3513 FreeIntRegs -= NeededInt; 3514 FreeSSERegs -= NeededSSE; 3515 } else { 3516 FI.getReturnInfo() = getIndirectReturnResult(FI.getReturnType()); 3517 } 3518 } else if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 3519 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 3520 3521 // If the return value is indirect, then the hidden argument is consuming one 3522 // integer register. 3523 if (FI.getReturnInfo().isIndirect()) 3524 --FreeIntRegs; 3525 3526 // The chain argument effectively gives us another free register. 3527 if (FI.isChainCall()) 3528 ++FreeIntRegs; 3529 3530 unsigned NumRequiredArgs = FI.getNumRequiredArgs(); 3531 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Once arguments are classified, the registers 3532 // get assigned (in left-to-right order) for passing as follows... 3533 unsigned ArgNo = 0; 3534 for (CGFunctionInfo::arg_iterator it = FI.arg_begin(), ie = FI.arg_end(); 3535 it != ie; ++it, ++ArgNo) { 3536 bool IsNamedArg = ArgNo < NumRequiredArgs; 3537 3538 if (IsRegCall && it->type->isStructureOrClassType()) 3539 it->info = classifyRegCallStructType(it->type, NeededInt, NeededSSE); 3540 else 3541 it->info = classifyArgumentType(it->type, FreeIntRegs, NeededInt, 3542 NeededSSE, IsNamedArg); 3543 3544 // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: If there are no registers available for any 3545 // eightbyte of an argument, the whole argument is passed on the 3546 // stack. If registers have already been assigned for some 3547 // eightbytes of such an argument, the assignments get reverted. 3548 if (FreeIntRegs >= NeededInt && FreeSSERegs >= NeededSSE) { 3549 FreeIntRegs -= NeededInt; 3550 FreeSSERegs -= NeededSSE; 3551 } else { 3552 it->info = getIndirectResult(it->type, FreeIntRegs); 3553 } 3554 } 3555 } 3556 3557 static Address EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CodeGenFunction &CGF, 3558 Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) { 3559 Address overflow_arg_area_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP( 3560 VAListAddr, 2, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), "overflow_arg_area_p"); 3561 llvm::Value *overflow_arg_area = 3562 CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(overflow_arg_area_p, "overflow_arg_area"); 3563 3564 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 7. Align l->overflow_arg_area upwards to a 16 3565 // byte boundary if alignment needed by type exceeds 8 byte boundary. 3566 // It isn't stated explicitly in the standard, but in practice we use 3567 // alignment greater than 16 where necessary. 3568 CharUnits Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty); 3569 if (Align > CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)) { 3570 overflow_arg_area = emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, overflow_arg_area, 3571 Align); 3572 } 3573 3574 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 8. Fetch type from l->overflow_arg_area. 3575 llvm::Type *LTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 3576 llvm::Value *Res = 3577 CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(overflow_arg_area, 3578 llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(LTy)); 3579 3580 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 9. Set l->overflow_arg_area to: 3581 // l->overflow_arg_area + sizeof(type). 3582 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 10. Align l->overflow_arg_area upwards to 3583 // an 8 byte boundary. 3584 3585 uint64_t SizeInBytes = (CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 7) / 8; 3586 llvm::Value *Offset = 3587 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, (SizeInBytes + 7) & ~7); 3588 overflow_arg_area = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(overflow_arg_area, Offset, 3589 "overflow_arg_area.next"); 3590 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(overflow_arg_area, overflow_arg_area_p); 3591 3592 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 11. Return the fetched type. 3593 return Address(Res, Align); 3594 } 3595 3596 Address X86_64ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3597 QualType Ty) const { 3598 // Assume that va_list type is correct; should be pointer to LLVM type: 3599 // struct { 3600 // i32 gp_offset; 3601 // i32 fp_offset; 3602 // i8* overflow_arg_area; 3603 // i8* reg_save_area; 3604 // }; 3605 unsigned neededInt, neededSSE; 3606 3607 Ty = getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty); 3608 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty, 0, neededInt, neededSSE, 3609 /*isNamedArg*/false); 3610 3611 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 1. Determine whether type may be passed 3612 // in the registers. If not go to step 7. 3613 if (!neededInt && !neededSSE) 3614 return EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty); 3615 3616 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 2. Compute num_gp to hold the number of 3617 // general purpose registers needed to pass type and num_fp to hold 3618 // the number of floating point registers needed. 3619 3620 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 3. Verify whether arguments fit into 3621 // registers. In the case: l->gp_offset > 48 - num_gp * 8 or 3622 // l->fp_offset > 304 - num_fp * 16 go to step 7. 3623 // 3624 // NOTE: 304 is a typo, there are (6 * 8 + 8 * 16) = 176 bytes of 3625 // register save space). 3626 3627 llvm::Value *InRegs = nullptr; 3628 Address gp_offset_p = Address::invalid(), fp_offset_p = Address::invalid(); 3629 llvm::Value *gp_offset = nullptr, *fp_offset = nullptr; 3630 if (neededInt) { 3631 gp_offset_p = 3632 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 0, CharUnits::Zero(), 3633 "gp_offset_p"); 3634 gp_offset = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(gp_offset_p, "gp_offset"); 3635 InRegs = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 48 - neededInt * 8); 3636 InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULE(gp_offset, InRegs, "fits_in_gp"); 3637 } 3638 3639 if (neededSSE) { 3640 fp_offset_p = 3641 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 1, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 3642 "fp_offset_p"); 3643 fp_offset = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(fp_offset_p, "fp_offset"); 3644 llvm::Value *FitsInFP = 3645 llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 176 - neededSSE * 16); 3646 FitsInFP = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULE(fp_offset, FitsInFP, "fits_in_fp"); 3647 InRegs = InRegs ? CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(InRegs, FitsInFP) : FitsInFP; 3648 } 3649 3650 llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg"); 3651 llvm::BasicBlock *InMemBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_mem"); 3652 llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end"); 3653 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, InMemBlock); 3654 3655 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in registers. 3656 3657 CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock); 3658 3659 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 4. Fetch type from l->reg_save_area with 3660 // an offset of l->gp_offset and/or l->fp_offset. This may require 3661 // copying to a temporary location in case the parameter is passed 3662 // in different register classes or requires an alignment greater 3663 // than 8 for general purpose registers and 16 for XMM registers. 3664 // 3665 // FIXME: This really results in shameful code when we end up needing to 3666 // collect arguments from different places; often what should result in a 3667 // simple assembling of a structure from scattered addresses has many more 3668 // loads than necessary. Can we clean this up? 3669 llvm::Type *LTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 3670 llvm::Value *RegSaveArea = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad( 3671 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)), 3672 "reg_save_area"); 3673 3674 Address RegAddr = Address::invalid(); 3675 if (neededInt && neededSSE) { 3676 // FIXME: Cleanup. 3677 assert(AI.isDirect() && "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs"); 3678 llvm::StructType *ST = cast<llvm::StructType>(AI.getCoerceToType()); 3679 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty); 3680 Tmp = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, ST); 3681 assert(ST->getNumElements() == 2 && "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs"); 3682 llvm::Type *TyLo = ST->getElementType(0); 3683 llvm::Type *TyHi = ST->getElementType(1); 3684 assert((TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ^ TyHi->isFPOrFPVectorTy()) && 3685 "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs"); 3686 llvm::Type *PTyLo = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(TyLo); 3687 llvm::Type *PTyHi = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(TyHi); 3688 llvm::Value *GPAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, gp_offset); 3689 llvm::Value *FPAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset); 3690 llvm::Value *RegLoAddr = TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ? FPAddr : GPAddr; 3691 llvm::Value *RegHiAddr = TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ? GPAddr : FPAddr; 3692 3693 // Copy the first element. 3694 // FIXME: Our choice of alignment here and below is probably pessimistic. 3695 llvm::Value *V = CGF.Builder.CreateAlignedLoad( 3696 TyLo, CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(RegLoAddr, PTyLo), 3697 CharUnits::fromQuantity(getDataLayout().getABITypeAlignment(TyLo))); 3698 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, 3699 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 0, CharUnits::Zero())); 3700 3701 // Copy the second element. 3702 V = CGF.Builder.CreateAlignedLoad( 3703 TyHi, CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(RegHiAddr, PTyHi), 3704 CharUnits::fromQuantity(getDataLayout().getABITypeAlignment(TyHi))); 3705 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::fromQuantity( 3706 getDataLayout().getStructLayout(ST)->getElementOffset(1)); 3707 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 1, Offset)); 3708 3709 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, LTy); 3710 } else if (neededInt) { 3711 RegAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, gp_offset), 3712 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 3713 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, LTy); 3714 3715 // Copy to a temporary if necessary to ensure the appropriate alignment. 3716 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> SizeAlign = 3717 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 3718 uint64_t TySize = SizeAlign.first.getQuantity(); 3719 CharUnits TyAlign = SizeAlign.second; 3720 3721 // Copy into a temporary if the type is more aligned than the 3722 // register save area. 3723 if (TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) { 3724 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty); 3725 CGF.Builder.CreateMemCpy(Tmp, RegAddr, TySize, false); 3726 RegAddr = Tmp; 3727 } 3728 3729 } else if (neededSSE == 1) { 3730 RegAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset), 3731 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 3732 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, LTy); 3733 } else { 3734 assert(neededSSE == 2 && "Invalid number of needed registers!"); 3735 // SSE registers are spaced 16 bytes apart in the register save 3736 // area, we need to collect the two eightbytes together. 3737 // The ABI isn't explicit about this, but it seems reasonable 3738 // to assume that the slots are 16-byte aligned, since the stack is 3739 // naturally 16-byte aligned and the prologue is expected to store 3740 // all the SSE registers to the RSA. 3741 Address RegAddrLo = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset), 3742 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 3743 Address RegAddrHi = 3744 CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RegAddrLo, 3745 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 3746 llvm::Type *DoubleTy = CGF.DoubleTy; 3747 llvm::StructType *ST = llvm::StructType::get(DoubleTy, DoubleTy); 3748 llvm::Value *V; 3749 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty); 3750 Tmp = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, ST); 3751 V = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad( 3752 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddrLo, DoubleTy)); 3753 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, 3754 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 0, CharUnits::Zero())); 3755 V = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad( 3756 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddrHi, DoubleTy)); 3757 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, 3758 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 1, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8))); 3759 3760 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, LTy); 3761 } 3762 3763 // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 5. Set: 3764 // l->gp_offset = l->gp_offset + num_gp * 8 3765 // l->fp_offset = l->fp_offset + num_fp * 16. 3766 if (neededInt) { 3767 llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, neededInt * 8); 3768 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(gp_offset, Offset), 3769 gp_offset_p); 3770 } 3771 if (neededSSE) { 3772 llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, neededSSE * 16); 3773 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(fp_offset, Offset), 3774 fp_offset_p); 3775 } 3776 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 3777 3778 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in memory. 3779 3780 CGF.EmitBlock(InMemBlock); 3781 Address MemAddr = EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty); 3782 3783 // Return the appropriate result. 3784 3785 CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock); 3786 Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, MemAddr, InMemBlock, 3787 "vaarg.addr"); 3788 return ResAddr; 3789 } 3790 3791 Address X86_64ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3792 QualType Ty) const { 3793 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 3794 CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 3795 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), 3796 /*allowHigherAlign*/ false); 3797 } 3798 3799 ABIArgInfo 3800 WinX86_64ABIInfo::reclassifyHvaArgType(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, 3801 const ABIArgInfo ¤t) const { 3802 // Assumes vectorCall calling convention. 3803 const Type *Base = nullptr; 3804 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 3805 3806 if (!Ty->isBuiltinType() && !Ty->isVectorType() && 3807 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts) && FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 3808 FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 3809 return getDirectX86Hva(); 3810 } 3811 return current; 3812 } 3813 3814 ABIArgInfo WinX86_64ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, 3815 bool IsReturnType, bool IsVectorCall, 3816 bool IsRegCall) const { 3817 3818 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 3819 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 3820 3821 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 3822 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 3823 3824 TypeInfo Info = getContext().getTypeInfo(Ty); 3825 uint64_t Width = Info.Width; 3826 CharUnits Align = getContext().toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align); 3827 3828 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 3829 if (RT) { 3830 if (!IsReturnType) { 3831 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI())) 3832 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 3833 } 3834 3835 if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 3836 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 3837 3838 } 3839 3840 const Type *Base = nullptr; 3841 uint64_t NumElts = 0; 3842 // vectorcall adds the concept of a homogenous vector aggregate, similar to 3843 // other targets. 3844 if ((IsVectorCall || IsRegCall) && 3845 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) { 3846 if (IsRegCall) { 3847 if (FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) { 3848 FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 3849 if (IsReturnType || Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType()) 3850 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3851 return ABIArgInfo::getExpand(); 3852 } 3853 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false); 3854 } else if (IsVectorCall) { 3855 if (FreeSSERegs >= NumElts && 3856 (IsReturnType || Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType())) { 3857 FreeSSERegs -= NumElts; 3858 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3859 } else if (IsReturnType) { 3860 return ABIArgInfo::getExpand(); 3861 } else if (!Ty->isBuiltinType() && !Ty->isVectorType()) { 3862 // HVAs are delayed and reclassified in the 2nd step. 3863 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false); 3864 } 3865 } 3866 } 3867 3868 if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 3869 // If the member pointer is represented by an LLVM int or ptr, pass it 3870 // directly. 3871 llvm::Type *LLTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 3872 if (LLTy->isPointerTy() || LLTy->isIntegerTy()) 3873 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3874 } 3875 3876 if (RT || Ty->isAnyComplexType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 3877 // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is 3878 // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference." 3879 if (Width > 64 || !llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width)) 3880 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 3881 3882 // Otherwise, coerce it to a small integer. 3883 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Width)); 3884 } 3885 3886 // Bool type is always extended to the ABI, other builtin types are not 3887 // extended. 3888 const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 3889 if (BT && BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Bool) 3890 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 3891 3892 // Mingw64 GCC uses the old 80 bit extended precision floating point unit. It 3893 // passes them indirectly through memory. 3894 if (IsMingw64 && BT && BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) { 3895 const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat(); 3896 if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended()) 3897 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false); 3898 } 3899 3900 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 3901 } 3902 3903 void WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, 3904 unsigned FreeSSERegs, 3905 bool IsVectorCall, 3906 bool IsRegCall) const { 3907 unsigned Count = 0; 3908 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 3909 // Vectorcall in x64 only permits the first 6 arguments to be passed 3910 // as XMM/YMM registers. 3911 if (Count < VectorcallMaxParamNumAsReg) 3912 I.info = classify(I.type, FreeSSERegs, false, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall); 3913 else { 3914 // Since these cannot be passed in registers, pretend no registers 3915 // are left. 3916 unsigned ZeroSSERegsAvail = 0; 3917 I.info = classify(I.type, /*FreeSSERegs=*/ZeroSSERegsAvail, false, 3918 IsVectorCall, IsRegCall); 3919 } 3920 ++Count; 3921 } 3922 3923 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 3924 I.info = reclassifyHvaArgType(I.type, FreeSSERegs, I.info); 3925 } 3926 } 3927 3928 void WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 3929 bool IsVectorCall = 3930 FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall; 3931 bool IsRegCall = FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall; 3932 3933 unsigned FreeSSERegs = 0; 3934 if (IsVectorCall) { 3935 // We can use up to 4 SSE return registers with vectorcall. 3936 FreeSSERegs = 4; 3937 } else if (IsRegCall) { 3938 // RegCall gives us 16 SSE registers. 3939 FreeSSERegs = 16; 3940 } 3941 3942 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 3943 FI.getReturnInfo() = classify(FI.getReturnType(), FreeSSERegs, true, 3944 IsVectorCall, IsRegCall); 3945 3946 if (IsVectorCall) { 3947 // We can use up to 6 SSE register parameters with vectorcall. 3948 FreeSSERegs = 6; 3949 } else if (IsRegCall) { 3950 // RegCall gives us 16 SSE registers, we can reuse the return registers. 3951 FreeSSERegs = 16; 3952 } 3953 3954 if (IsVectorCall) { 3955 computeVectorCallArgs(FI, FreeSSERegs, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall); 3956 } else { 3957 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 3958 I.info = classify(I.type, FreeSSERegs, false, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall); 3959 } 3960 3961 } 3962 3963 Address WinX86_64ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3964 QualType Ty) const { 3965 3966 bool IsIndirect = false; 3967 3968 // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is 3969 // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference." 3970 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 3971 uint64_t Width = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 3972 IsIndirect = Width > 64 || !llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width); 3973 } 3974 3975 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, 3976 CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 3977 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), 3978 /*allowHigherAlign*/ false); 3979 } 3980 3981 // PowerPC-32 3982 namespace { 3983 /// PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo - The 32-bit PowerPC ELF (SVR4) ABI information. 3984 class PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 3985 bool IsSoftFloatABI; 3986 public: 3987 PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool SoftFloatABI) 3988 : DefaultABIInfo(CGT), IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI) {} 3989 3990 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 3991 QualType Ty) const override; 3992 }; 3993 3994 class PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 3995 public: 3996 PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool SoftFloatABI) 3997 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo(CGT, SoftFloatABI)) {} 3998 3999 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 4000 // This is recovered from gcc output. 4001 return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer 4002 } 4003 4004 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4005 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 4006 }; 4007 4008 } 4009 4010 // TODO: this implementation is now likely redundant with 4011 // DefaultABIInfo::EmitVAArg. 4012 Address PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAList, 4013 QualType Ty) const { 4014 const unsigned OverflowLimit = 8; 4015 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 4016 // TODO: Implement this. For now ignore. 4017 (void)CTy; 4018 return Address::invalid(); // FIXME? 4019 } 4020 4021 // struct __va_list_tag { 4022 // unsigned char gpr; 4023 // unsigned char fpr; 4024 // unsigned short reserved; 4025 // void *overflow_arg_area; 4026 // void *reg_save_area; 4027 // }; 4028 4029 bool isI64 = Ty->isIntegerType() && getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 64; 4030 bool isInt = 4031 Ty->isIntegerType() || Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isAggregateType(); 4032 bool isF64 = Ty->isFloatingType() && getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 64; 4033 4034 // All aggregates are passed indirectly? That doesn't seem consistent 4035 // with the argument-lowering code. 4036 bool isIndirect = Ty->isAggregateType(); 4037 4038 CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 4039 4040 // The calling convention either uses 1-2 GPRs or 1 FPR. 4041 Address NumRegsAddr = Address::invalid(); 4042 if (isInt || IsSoftFloatABI) { 4043 NumRegsAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 0, CharUnits::Zero(), "gpr"); 4044 } else { 4045 NumRegsAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 1, CharUnits::One(), "fpr"); 4046 } 4047 4048 llvm::Value *NumRegs = Builder.CreateLoad(NumRegsAddr, "numUsedRegs"); 4049 4050 // "Align" the register count when TY is i64. 4051 if (isI64 || (isF64 && IsSoftFloatABI)) { 4052 NumRegs = Builder.CreateAdd(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(1)); 4053 NumRegs = Builder.CreateAnd(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8((uint8_t) ~1U)); 4054 } 4055 4056 llvm::Value *CC = 4057 Builder.CreateICmpULT(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(OverflowLimit), "cond"); 4058 4059 llvm::BasicBlock *UsingRegs = CGF.createBasicBlock("using_regs"); 4060 llvm::BasicBlock *UsingOverflow = CGF.createBasicBlock("using_overflow"); 4061 llvm::BasicBlock *Cont = CGF.createBasicBlock("cont"); 4062 4063 Builder.CreateCondBr(CC, UsingRegs, UsingOverflow); 4064 4065 llvm::Type *DirectTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty); 4066 if (isIndirect) DirectTy = DirectTy->getPointerTo(0); 4067 4068 // Case 1: consume registers. 4069 Address RegAddr = Address::invalid(); 4070 { 4071 CGF.EmitBlock(UsingRegs); 4072 4073 Address RegSaveAreaPtr = 4074 Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 4, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 4075 RegAddr = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(RegSaveAreaPtr), 4076 CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 4077 assert(RegAddr.getElementType() == CGF.Int8Ty); 4078 4079 // Floating-point registers start after the general-purpose registers. 4080 if (!(isInt || IsSoftFloatABI)) { 4081 RegAddr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RegAddr, 4082 CharUnits::fromQuantity(32)); 4083 } 4084 4085 // Get the address of the saved value by scaling the number of 4086 // registers we've used by the number of 4087 CharUnits RegSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity((isInt || IsSoftFloatABI) ? 4 : 8); 4088 llvm::Value *RegOffset = 4089 Builder.CreateMul(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(RegSize.getQuantity())); 4090 RegAddr = Address(Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(CGF.Int8Ty, 4091 RegAddr.getPointer(), RegOffset), 4092 RegAddr.getAlignment().alignmentOfArrayElement(RegSize)); 4093 RegAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, DirectTy); 4094 4095 // Increase the used-register count. 4096 NumRegs = 4097 Builder.CreateAdd(NumRegs, 4098 Builder.getInt8((isI64 || (isF64 && IsSoftFloatABI)) ? 2 : 1)); 4099 Builder.CreateStore(NumRegs, NumRegsAddr); 4100 4101 CGF.EmitBranch(Cont); 4102 } 4103 4104 // Case 2: consume space in the overflow area. 4105 Address MemAddr = Address::invalid(); 4106 { 4107 CGF.EmitBlock(UsingOverflow); 4108 4109 Builder.CreateStore(Builder.getInt8(OverflowLimit), NumRegsAddr); 4110 4111 // Everything in the overflow area is rounded up to a size of at least 4. 4112 CharUnits OverflowAreaAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 4113 4114 CharUnits Size; 4115 if (!isIndirect) { 4116 auto TypeInfo = CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 4117 Size = TypeInfo.first.alignTo(OverflowAreaAlign); 4118 } else { 4119 Size = CGF.getPointerSize(); 4120 } 4121 4122 Address OverflowAreaAddr = 4123 Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4)); 4124 Address OverflowArea(Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowAreaAddr, "argp.cur"), 4125 OverflowAreaAlign); 4126 // Round up address of argument to alignment 4127 CharUnits Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty); 4128 if (Align > OverflowAreaAlign) { 4129 llvm::Value *Ptr = OverflowArea.getPointer(); 4130 OverflowArea = Address(emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, Ptr, Align), 4131 Align); 4132 } 4133 4134 MemAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OverflowArea, DirectTy); 4135 4136 // Increase the overflow area. 4137 OverflowArea = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(OverflowArea, Size); 4138 Builder.CreateStore(OverflowArea.getPointer(), OverflowAreaAddr); 4139 CGF.EmitBranch(Cont); 4140 } 4141 4142 CGF.EmitBlock(Cont); 4143 4144 // Merge the cases with a phi. 4145 Address Result = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, UsingRegs, MemAddr, UsingOverflow, 4146 "vaarg.addr"); 4147 4148 // Load the pointer if the argument was passed indirectly. 4149 if (isIndirect) { 4150 Result = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(Result, "aggr"), 4151 getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty)); 4152 } 4153 4154 return Result; 4155 } 4156 4157 bool 4158 PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4159 llvm::Value *Address) const { 4160 // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified 4161 // against gcc output. AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding. 4162 4163 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 4164 4165 llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty; 4166 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4); 4167 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8); 4168 llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 16); 4169 4170 // 0-31: r0-31, the 4-byte general-purpose registers 4171 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 31); 4172 4173 // 32-63: fp0-31, the 8-byte floating-point registers 4174 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 32, 63); 4175 4176 // 64-76 are various 4-byte special-purpose registers: 4177 // 64: mq 4178 // 65: lr 4179 // 66: ctr 4180 // 67: ap 4181 // 68-75 cr0-7 4182 // 76: xer 4183 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 64, 76); 4184 4185 // 77-108: v0-31, the 16-byte vector registers 4186 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 77, 108); 4187 4188 // 109: vrsave 4189 // 110: vscr 4190 // 111: spe_acc 4191 // 112: spefscr 4192 // 113: sfp 4193 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 109, 113); 4194 4195 return false; 4196 } 4197 4198 // PowerPC-64 4199 4200 namespace { 4201 /// PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo - The 64-bit PowerPC ELF (SVR4) ABI information. 4202 class PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 4203 public: 4204 enum ABIKind { 4205 ELFv1 = 0, 4206 ELFv2 4207 }; 4208 4209 private: 4210 static const unsigned GPRBits = 64; 4211 ABIKind Kind; 4212 bool HasQPX; 4213 bool IsSoftFloatABI; 4214 4215 // A vector of float or double will be promoted to <4 x f32> or <4 x f64> and 4216 // will be passed in a QPX register. 4217 bool IsQPXVectorTy(const Type *Ty) const { 4218 if (!HasQPX) 4219 return false; 4220 4221 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4222 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 4223 if (NumElements == 1) 4224 return false; 4225 4226 if (VT->getElementType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double)) { 4227 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 256) 4228 return true; 4229 } else if (VT->getElementType()-> 4230 isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) { 4231 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 128) 4232 return true; 4233 } 4234 } 4235 4236 return false; 4237 } 4238 4239 bool IsQPXVectorTy(QualType Ty) const { 4240 return IsQPXVectorTy(Ty.getTypePtr()); 4241 } 4242 4243 public: 4244 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind, bool HasQPX, 4245 bool SoftFloatABI) 4246 : ABIInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind), HasQPX(HasQPX), 4247 IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI) {} 4248 4249 bool isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const; 4250 CharUnits getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const; 4251 4252 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 4253 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 4254 4255 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override; 4256 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 4257 uint64_t Members) const override; 4258 4259 // TODO: We can add more logic to computeInfo to improve performance. 4260 // Example: For aggregate arguments that fit in a register, we could 4261 // use getDirectInReg (as is done below for structs containing a single 4262 // floating-point value) to avoid pushing them to memory on function 4263 // entry. This would require changing the logic in PPCISelLowering 4264 // when lowering the parameters in the caller and args in the callee. 4265 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 4266 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 4267 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 4268 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) { 4269 // We rely on the default argument classification for the most part. 4270 // One exception: An aggregate containing a single floating-point 4271 // or vector item must be passed in a register if one is available. 4272 const Type *T = isSingleElementStruct(I.type, getContext()); 4273 if (T) { 4274 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 4275 if (IsQPXVectorTy(T) || 4276 (T->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(T) == 128) || 4277 (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint())) { 4278 QualType QT(T, 0); 4279 I.info = ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(CGT.ConvertType(QT)); 4280 continue; 4281 } 4282 } 4283 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 4284 } 4285 } 4286 4287 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4288 QualType Ty) const override; 4289 }; 4290 4291 class PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 4292 4293 public: 4294 PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, 4295 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind, bool HasQPX, 4296 bool SoftFloatABI) 4297 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo(CGT, Kind, HasQPX, 4298 SoftFloatABI)) {} 4299 4300 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 4301 // This is recovered from gcc output. 4302 return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer 4303 } 4304 4305 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4306 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 4307 }; 4308 4309 class PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo : public DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo { 4310 public: 4311 PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT) {} 4312 4313 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 4314 // This is recovered from gcc output. 4315 return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer 4316 } 4317 4318 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4319 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 4320 }; 4321 4322 } 4323 4324 // Return true if the ABI requires Ty to be passed sign- or zero- 4325 // extended to 64 bits. 4326 bool 4327 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const { 4328 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 4329 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 4330 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 4331 4332 // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI. 4333 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) 4334 return true; 4335 4336 // In addition to the usual promotable integer types, we also need to 4337 // extend all 32-bit types, since the ABI requires promotion to 64 bits. 4338 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 4339 switch (BT->getKind()) { 4340 case BuiltinType::Int: 4341 case BuiltinType::UInt: 4342 return true; 4343 default: 4344 break; 4345 } 4346 4347 return false; 4348 } 4349 4350 /// isAlignedParamType - Determine whether a type requires 16-byte or 4351 /// higher alignment in the parameter area. Always returns at least 8. 4352 CharUnits PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const { 4353 // Complex types are passed just like their elements. 4354 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) 4355 Ty = CTy->getElementType(); 4356 4357 // Only vector types of size 16 bytes need alignment (larger types are 4358 // passed via reference, smaller types are not aligned). 4359 if (IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) { 4360 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) > 128) 4361 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32); 4362 4363 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 4364 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 4365 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 128 ? 16 : 8); 4366 } 4367 4368 // For single-element float/vector structs, we consider the whole type 4369 // to have the same alignment requirements as its single element. 4370 const Type *AlignAsType = nullptr; 4371 const Type *EltType = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()); 4372 if (EltType) { 4373 const BuiltinType *BT = EltType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 4374 if (IsQPXVectorTy(EltType) || (EltType->isVectorType() && 4375 getContext().getTypeSize(EltType) == 128) || 4376 (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint())) 4377 AlignAsType = EltType; 4378 } 4379 4380 // Likewise for ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates. 4381 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4382 uint64_t Members = 0; 4383 if (!AlignAsType && Kind == ELFv2 && 4384 isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) 4385 AlignAsType = Base; 4386 4387 // With special case aggregates, only vector base types need alignment. 4388 if (AlignAsType && IsQPXVectorTy(AlignAsType)) { 4389 if (getContext().getTypeSize(AlignAsType) > 128) 4390 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32); 4391 4392 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 4393 } else if (AlignAsType) { 4394 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(AlignAsType->isVectorType() ? 16 : 8); 4395 } 4396 4397 // Otherwise, we only need alignment for any aggregate type that 4398 // has an alignment requirement of >= 16 bytes. 4399 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) >= 128) { 4400 if (HasQPX && getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) >= 256) 4401 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32); 4402 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 4403 } 4404 4405 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 4406 } 4407 4408 /// isHomogeneousAggregate - Return true if a type is an ELFv2 homogeneous 4409 /// aggregate. Base is set to the base element type, and Members is set 4410 /// to the number of base elements. 4411 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregate(QualType Ty, const Type *&Base, 4412 uint64_t &Members) const { 4413 if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) { 4414 uint64_t NElements = AT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 4415 if (NElements == 0) 4416 return false; 4417 if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(AT->getElementType(), Base, Members)) 4418 return false; 4419 Members *= NElements; 4420 } else if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 4421 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 4422 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 4423 return false; 4424 4425 Members = 0; 4426 4427 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 4428 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 4429 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 4430 // Ignore empty records. 4431 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), I.getType(), true)) 4432 continue; 4433 4434 uint64_t FldMembers; 4435 if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(I.getType(), Base, FldMembers)) 4436 return false; 4437 4438 Members += FldMembers; 4439 } 4440 } 4441 4442 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 4443 // Ignore (non-zero arrays of) empty records. 4444 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 4445 while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = 4446 getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) { 4447 if (AT->getSize().getZExtValue() == 0) 4448 return false; 4449 FT = AT->getElementType(); 4450 } 4451 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), FT, true)) 4452 continue; 4453 4454 // For compatibility with GCC, ignore empty bitfields in C++ mode. 4455 if (getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4456 FD->isBitField() && FD->getBitWidthValue(getContext()) == 0) 4457 continue; 4458 4459 uint64_t FldMembers; 4460 if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(FD->getType(), Base, FldMembers)) 4461 return false; 4462 4463 Members = (RD->isUnion() ? 4464 std::max(Members, FldMembers) : Members + FldMembers); 4465 } 4466 4467 if (!Base) 4468 return false; 4469 4470 // Ensure there is no padding. 4471 if (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) * Members != 4472 getContext().getTypeSize(Ty)) 4473 return false; 4474 } else { 4475 Members = 1; 4476 if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 4477 Members = 2; 4478 Ty = CT->getElementType(); 4479 } 4480 4481 // Most ABIs only support float, double, and some vector type widths. 4482 if (!isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(Ty)) 4483 return false; 4484 4485 // The base type must be the same for all members. Types that 4486 // agree in both total size and mode (float vs. vector) are 4487 // treated as being equivalent here. 4488 const Type *TyPtr = Ty.getTypePtr(); 4489 if (!Base) { 4490 Base = TyPtr; 4491 // If it's a non-power-of-2 vector, its size is already a power-of-2, 4492 // so make sure to widen it explicitly. 4493 if (const VectorType *VT = Base->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4494 QualType EltTy = VT->getElementType(); 4495 unsigned NumElements = 4496 getContext().getTypeSize(VT) / getContext().getTypeSize(EltTy); 4497 Base = getContext() 4498 .getVectorType(EltTy, NumElements, VT->getVectorKind()) 4499 .getTypePtr(); 4500 } 4501 } 4502 4503 if (Base->isVectorType() != TyPtr->isVectorType() || 4504 getContext().getTypeSize(Base) != getContext().getTypeSize(TyPtr)) 4505 return false; 4506 } 4507 return Members > 0 && isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(Base, Members); 4508 } 4509 4510 bool PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 4511 // Homogeneous aggregates for ELFv2 must have base types of float, 4512 // double, long double, or 128-bit vectors. 4513 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 4514 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 4515 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double || 4516 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) { 4517 if (IsSoftFloatABI) 4518 return false; 4519 return true; 4520 } 4521 } 4522 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4523 if (getContext().getTypeSize(VT) == 128 || IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) 4524 return true; 4525 } 4526 return false; 4527 } 4528 4529 bool PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough( 4530 const Type *Base, uint64_t Members) const { 4531 // Vector types require one register, floating point types require one 4532 // or two registers depending on their size. 4533 uint32_t NumRegs = 4534 Base->isVectorType() ? 1 : (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) + 63) / 64; 4535 4536 // Homogeneous Aggregates may occupy at most 8 registers. 4537 return Members * NumRegs <= 8; 4538 } 4539 4540 ABIArgInfo 4541 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 4542 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 4543 4544 if (Ty->isAnyComplexType()) 4545 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 4546 4547 // Non-Altivec vector types are passed in GPRs (smaller than 16 bytes) 4548 // or via reference (larger than 16 bytes). 4549 if (Ty->isVectorType() && !IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) { 4550 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4551 if (Size > 128) 4552 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 4553 else if (Size < 128) { 4554 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size); 4555 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4556 } 4557 } 4558 4559 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 4560 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 4561 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 4562 4563 uint64_t ABIAlign = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty).getQuantity(); 4564 uint64_t TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty).getQuantity(); 4565 4566 // ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates are passed as array types. 4567 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4568 uint64_t Members = 0; 4569 if (Kind == ELFv2 && 4570 isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 4571 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)); 4572 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Members); 4573 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4574 } 4575 4576 // If an aggregate may end up fully in registers, we do not 4577 // use the ByVal method, but pass the aggregate as array. 4578 // This is usually beneficial since we avoid forcing the 4579 // back-end to store the argument to memory. 4580 uint64_t Bits = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4581 if (Bits > 0 && Bits <= 8 * GPRBits) { 4582 llvm::Type *CoerceTy; 4583 4584 // Types up to 8 bytes are passed as integer type (which will be 4585 // properly aligned in the argument save area doubleword). 4586 if (Bits <= GPRBits) 4587 CoerceTy = 4588 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), llvm::alignTo(Bits, 8)); 4589 // Larger types are passed as arrays, with the base type selected 4590 // according to the required alignment in the save area. 4591 else { 4592 uint64_t RegBits = ABIAlign * 8; 4593 uint64_t NumRegs = llvm::alignTo(Bits, RegBits) / RegBits; 4594 llvm::Type *RegTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), RegBits); 4595 CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(RegTy, NumRegs); 4596 } 4597 4598 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4599 } 4600 4601 // All other aggregates are passed ByVal. 4602 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(ABIAlign), 4603 /*ByVal=*/true, 4604 /*Realign=*/TyAlign > ABIAlign); 4605 } 4606 4607 return (isPromotableTypeForABI(Ty) ? 4608 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4609 } 4610 4611 ABIArgInfo 4612 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 4613 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 4614 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4615 4616 if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 4617 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 4618 4619 // Non-Altivec vector types are returned in GPRs (smaller than 16 bytes) 4620 // or via reference (larger than 16 bytes). 4621 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && !IsQPXVectorTy(RetTy)) { 4622 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 4623 if (Size > 128) 4624 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 4625 else if (Size < 128) { 4626 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size); 4627 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4628 } 4629 } 4630 4631 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 4632 // ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates are returned as array types. 4633 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4634 uint64_t Members = 0; 4635 if (Kind == ELFv2 && 4636 isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) { 4637 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)); 4638 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Members); 4639 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4640 } 4641 4642 // ELFv2 small aggregates are returned in up to two registers. 4643 uint64_t Bits = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 4644 if (Kind == ELFv2 && Bits <= 2 * GPRBits) { 4645 if (Bits == 0) 4646 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4647 4648 llvm::Type *CoerceTy; 4649 if (Bits > GPRBits) { 4650 CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), GPRBits); 4651 CoerceTy = llvm::StructType::get(CoerceTy, CoerceTy); 4652 } else 4653 CoerceTy = 4654 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), llvm::alignTo(Bits, 8)); 4655 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 4656 } 4657 4658 // All other aggregates are returned indirectly. 4659 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 4660 } 4661 4662 return (isPromotableTypeForABI(RetTy) ? 4663 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4664 } 4665 4666 // Based on ARMABIInfo::EmitVAArg, adjusted for 64-bit machine. 4667 Address PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4668 QualType Ty) const { 4669 auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 4670 TypeInfo.second = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty); 4671 4672 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 4673 4674 // If we have a complex type and the base type is smaller than 8 bytes, 4675 // the ABI calls for the real and imaginary parts to be right-adjusted 4676 // in separate doublewords. However, Clang expects us to produce a 4677 // pointer to a structure with the two parts packed tightly. So generate 4678 // loads of the real and imaginary parts relative to the va_list pointer, 4679 // and store them to a temporary structure. 4680 if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 4681 CharUnits EltSize = TypeInfo.first / 2; 4682 if (EltSize < SlotSize) { 4683 Address Addr = emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, CGF.Int8Ty, 4684 SlotSize * 2, SlotSize, 4685 SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true); 4686 4687 Address RealAddr = Addr; 4688 Address ImagAddr = RealAddr; 4689 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian()) { 4690 RealAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RealAddr, 4691 SlotSize - EltSize); 4692 ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(ImagAddr, 4693 2 * SlotSize - EltSize); 4694 } else { 4695 ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RealAddr, SlotSize); 4696 } 4697 4698 llvm::Type *EltTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(CTy->getElementType()); 4699 RealAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RealAddr, EltTy); 4700 ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(ImagAddr, EltTy); 4701 llvm::Value *Real = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RealAddr, ".vareal"); 4702 llvm::Value *Imag = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ImagAddr, ".vaimag"); 4703 4704 Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty, "vacplx"); 4705 CGF.EmitStoreOfComplex({Real, Imag}, CGF.MakeAddrLValue(Temp, Ty), 4706 /*init*/ true); 4707 return Temp; 4708 } 4709 } 4710 4711 // Otherwise, just use the general rule. 4712 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false, 4713 TypeInfo, SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true); 4714 } 4715 4716 static bool 4717 PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4718 llvm::Value *Address) { 4719 // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified 4720 // against gcc output. AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding. 4721 4722 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 4723 4724 llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty; 4725 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4); 4726 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8); 4727 llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 16); 4728 4729 // 0-31: r0-31, the 8-byte general-purpose registers 4730 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 31); 4731 4732 // 32-63: fp0-31, the 8-byte floating-point registers 4733 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 32, 63); 4734 4735 // 64-67 are various 8-byte special-purpose registers: 4736 // 64: mq 4737 // 65: lr 4738 // 66: ctr 4739 // 67: ap 4740 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 64, 67); 4741 4742 // 68-76 are various 4-byte special-purpose registers: 4743 // 68-75 cr0-7 4744 // 76: xer 4745 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 68, 76); 4746 4747 // 77-108: v0-31, the 16-byte vector registers 4748 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 77, 108); 4749 4750 // 109: vrsave 4751 // 110: vscr 4752 // 111: spe_acc 4753 // 112: spefscr 4754 // 113: sfp 4755 // 114: tfhar 4756 // 115: tfiar 4757 // 116: texasr 4758 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 109, 116); 4759 4760 return false; 4761 } 4762 4763 bool 4764 PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable( 4765 CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4766 llvm::Value *Address) const { 4767 4768 return PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address); 4769 } 4770 4771 bool 4772 PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 4773 llvm::Value *Address) const { 4774 4775 return PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address); 4776 } 4777 4778 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 4779 // AArch64 ABI Implementation 4780 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 4781 4782 namespace { 4783 4784 class AArch64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 4785 public: 4786 enum ABIKind { 4787 AAPCS = 0, 4788 DarwinPCS 4789 }; 4790 4791 private: 4792 ABIKind Kind; 4793 4794 public: 4795 AArch64ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind) 4796 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind) {} 4797 4798 private: 4799 ABIKind getABIKind() const { return Kind; } 4800 bool isDarwinPCS() const { return Kind == DarwinPCS; } 4801 4802 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 4803 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 4804 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override; 4805 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 4806 uint64_t Members) const override; 4807 4808 bool isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 4809 4810 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 4811 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 4812 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 4813 4814 for (auto &it : FI.arguments()) 4815 it.info = classifyArgumentType(it.type); 4816 } 4817 4818 Address EmitDarwinVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 4819 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const; 4820 4821 Address EmitAAPCSVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 4822 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const; 4823 4824 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 4825 QualType Ty) const override { 4826 return isDarwinPCS() ? EmitDarwinVAArg(VAListAddr, Ty, CGF) 4827 : EmitAAPCSVAArg(VAListAddr, Ty, CGF); 4828 } 4829 4830 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 4831 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 4832 bool asReturnValue) const override { 4833 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 4834 } 4835 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 4836 return true; 4837 } 4838 4839 bool isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, llvm::Type *eltTy, 4840 unsigned elts) const override; 4841 }; 4842 4843 class AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 4844 public: 4845 AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind) 4846 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new AArch64ABIInfo(CGT, Kind)) {} 4847 4848 StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override { 4849 return "mov\tfp, fp\t\t# marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue"; 4850 } 4851 4852 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 4853 return 31; 4854 } 4855 4856 bool doesReturnSlotInterfereWithArgs() const override { return false; } 4857 }; 4858 } 4859 4860 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 4861 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 4862 4863 // Handle illegal vector types here. 4864 if (isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 4865 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4866 // Android promotes <2 x i8> to i16, not i32 4867 if (isAndroid() && (Size <= 16)) { 4868 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()); 4869 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 4870 } 4871 if (Size <= 32) { 4872 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 4873 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 4874 } 4875 if (Size == 64) { 4876 llvm::Type *ResType = 4877 llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 2); 4878 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 4879 } 4880 if (Size == 128) { 4881 llvm::Type *ResType = 4882 llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 4); 4883 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 4884 } 4885 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 4886 } 4887 4888 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 4889 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 4890 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 4891 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 4892 4893 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() && isDarwinPCS() 4894 ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend() 4895 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4896 } 4897 4898 // Structures with either a non-trivial destructor or a non-trivial 4899 // copy constructor are always indirect. 4900 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) { 4901 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/RAA == 4902 CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 4903 } 4904 4905 // Empty records are always ignored on Darwin, but actually passed in C++ mode 4906 // elsewhere for GNU compatibility. 4907 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 4908 bool IsEmpty = isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true); 4909 if (IsEmpty || Size == 0) { 4910 if (!getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || isDarwinPCS()) 4911 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4912 4913 // GNU C mode. The only argument that gets ignored is an empty one with size 4914 // 0. 4915 if (IsEmpty && Size == 0) 4916 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4917 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 4918 } 4919 4920 // Homogeneous Floating-point Aggregates (HFAs) need to be expanded. 4921 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4922 uint64_t Members = 0; 4923 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 4924 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect( 4925 llvm::ArrayType::get(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)), Members)); 4926 } 4927 4928 // Aggregates <= 16 bytes are passed directly in registers or on the stack. 4929 if (Size <= 128) { 4930 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 16 bytes to an integer array of 4931 // same size and alignment. 4932 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 4933 return coerceToIntArray(Ty, getContext(), getVMContext()); 4934 } 4935 unsigned Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty); 4936 Size = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64); // round up to multiple of 8 bytes 4937 4938 // We use a pair of i64 for 16-byte aggregate with 8-byte alignment. 4939 // For aggregates with 16-byte alignment, we use i128. 4940 if (Alignment < 128 && Size == 128) { 4941 llvm::Type *BaseTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()); 4942 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Size / 64)); 4943 } 4944 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size)); 4945 } 4946 4947 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 4948 } 4949 4950 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 4951 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 4952 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4953 4954 // Large vector types should be returned via memory. 4955 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 128) 4956 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 4957 4958 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 4959 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 4960 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 4961 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 4962 4963 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() && isDarwinPCS() 4964 ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend() 4965 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 4966 } 4967 4968 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 4969 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true) || Size == 0) 4970 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 4971 4972 const Type *Base = nullptr; 4973 uint64_t Members = 0; 4974 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) 4975 // Homogeneous Floating-point Aggregates (HFAs) are returned directly. 4976 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 4977 4978 // Aggregates <= 16 bytes are returned directly in registers or on the stack. 4979 if (Size <= 128) { 4980 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 16 bytes to an integer array of 4981 // same size and alignment. 4982 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 4983 return coerceToIntArray(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext()); 4984 } 4985 unsigned Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(RetTy); 4986 Size = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64); // round up to multiple of 8 bytes 4987 4988 // We use a pair of i64 for 16-byte aggregate with 8-byte alignment. 4989 // For aggregates with 16-byte alignment, we use i128. 4990 if (Alignment < 128 && Size == 128) { 4991 llvm::Type *BaseTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()); 4992 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Size / 64)); 4993 } 4994 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size)); 4995 } 4996 4997 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 4998 } 4999 5000 /// isIllegalVectorType - check whether the vector type is legal for AArch64. 5001 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 5002 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 5003 // Check whether VT is legal. 5004 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 5005 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 5006 // NumElements should be power of 2. 5007 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements)) 5008 return true; 5009 return Size != 64 && (Size != 128 || NumElements == 1); 5010 } 5011 return false; 5012 } 5013 5014 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 5015 llvm::Type *eltTy, 5016 unsigned elts) const { 5017 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(elts)) 5018 return false; 5019 if (totalSize.getQuantity() != 8 && 5020 (totalSize.getQuantity() != 16 || elts == 1)) 5021 return false; 5022 return true; 5023 } 5024 5025 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 5026 // Homogeneous aggregates for AAPCS64 must have base types of a floating 5027 // point type or a short-vector type. This is the same as the 32-bit ABI, 5028 // but with the difference that any floating-point type is allowed, 5029 // including __fp16. 5030 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 5031 if (BT->isFloatingPoint()) 5032 return true; 5033 } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 5034 unsigned VecSize = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 5035 if (VecSize == 64 || VecSize == 128) 5036 return true; 5037 } 5038 return false; 5039 } 5040 5041 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base, 5042 uint64_t Members) const { 5043 return Members <= 4; 5044 } 5045 5046 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitAAPCSVAArg(Address VAListAddr, 5047 QualType Ty, 5048 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const { 5049 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty); 5050 bool IsIndirect = AI.isIndirect(); 5051 5052 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty); 5053 if (IsIndirect) 5054 BaseTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(BaseTy); 5055 else if (AI.getCoerceToType()) 5056 BaseTy = AI.getCoerceToType(); 5057 5058 unsigned NumRegs = 1; 5059 if (llvm::ArrayType *ArrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(BaseTy)) { 5060 BaseTy = ArrTy->getElementType(); 5061 NumRegs = ArrTy->getNumElements(); 5062 } 5063 bool IsFPR = BaseTy->isFloatingPointTy() || BaseTy->isVectorTy(); 5064 5065 // The AArch64 va_list type and handling is specified in the Procedure Call 5066 // Standard, section B.4: 5067 // 5068 // struct { 5069 // void *__stack; 5070 // void *__gr_top; 5071 // void *__vr_top; 5072 // int __gr_offs; 5073 // int __vr_offs; 5074 // }; 5075 5076 llvm::BasicBlock *MaybeRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.maybe_reg"); 5077 llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg"); 5078 llvm::BasicBlock *OnStackBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.on_stack"); 5079 llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end"); 5080 5081 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 5082 CharUnits TyAlign = TyInfo.second; 5083 5084 Address reg_offs_p = Address::invalid(); 5085 llvm::Value *reg_offs = nullptr; 5086 int reg_top_index; 5087 CharUnits reg_top_offset; 5088 int RegSize = IsIndirect ? 8 : TyInfo.first.getQuantity(); 5089 if (!IsFPR) { 5090 // 3 is the field number of __gr_offs 5091 reg_offs_p = 5092 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(24), 5093 "gr_offs_p"); 5094 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_offs_p, "gr_offs"); 5095 reg_top_index = 1; // field number for __gr_top 5096 reg_top_offset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 5097 RegSize = llvm::alignTo(RegSize, 8); 5098 } else { 5099 // 4 is the field number of __vr_offs. 5100 reg_offs_p = 5101 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 4, CharUnits::fromQuantity(28), 5102 "vr_offs_p"); 5103 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_offs_p, "vr_offs"); 5104 reg_top_index = 2; // field number for __vr_top 5105 reg_top_offset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 5106 RegSize = 16 * NumRegs; 5107 } 5108 5109 //======================================= 5110 // Find out where argument was passed 5111 //======================================= 5112 5113 // If reg_offs >= 0 we're already using the stack for this type of 5114 // argument. We don't want to keep updating reg_offs (in case it overflows, 5115 // though anyone passing 2GB of arguments, each at most 16 bytes, deserves 5116 // whatever they get). 5117 llvm::Value *UsingStack = nullptr; 5118 UsingStack = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSGE( 5119 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 0)); 5120 5121 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(UsingStack, OnStackBlock, MaybeRegBlock); 5122 5123 // Otherwise, at least some kind of argument could go in these registers, the 5124 // question is whether this particular type is too big. 5125 CGF.EmitBlock(MaybeRegBlock); 5126 5127 // Integer arguments may need to correct register alignment (for example a 5128 // "struct { __int128 a; };" gets passed in x_2N, x_{2N+1}). In this case we 5129 // align __gr_offs to calculate the potential address. 5130 if (!IsFPR && !IsIndirect && TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) { 5131 int Align = TyAlign.getQuantity(); 5132 5133 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd( 5134 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, Align - 1), 5135 "align_regoffs"); 5136 reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd( 5137 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, -Align), 5138 "aligned_regoffs"); 5139 } 5140 5141 // Update the gr_offs/vr_offs pointer for next call to va_arg on this va_list. 5142 // The fact that this is done unconditionally reflects the fact that 5143 // allocating an argument to the stack also uses up all the remaining 5144 // registers of the appropriate kind. 5145 llvm::Value *NewOffset = nullptr; 5146 NewOffset = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd( 5147 reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, RegSize), "new_reg_offs"); 5148 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOffset, reg_offs_p); 5149 5150 // Now we're in a position to decide whether this argument really was in 5151 // registers or not. 5152 llvm::Value *InRegs = nullptr; 5153 InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSLE( 5154 NewOffset, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 0), "inreg"); 5155 5156 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, OnStackBlock); 5157 5158 //======================================= 5159 // Argument was in registers 5160 //======================================= 5161 5162 // Now we emit the code for if the argument was originally passed in 5163 // registers. First start the appropriate block: 5164 CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock); 5165 5166 llvm::Value *reg_top = nullptr; 5167 Address reg_top_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, reg_top_index, 5168 reg_top_offset, "reg_top_p"); 5169 reg_top = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_top_p, "reg_top"); 5170 Address BaseAddr(CGF.Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(reg_top, reg_offs), 5171 CharUnits::fromQuantity(IsFPR ? 16 : 8)); 5172 Address RegAddr = Address::invalid(); 5173 llvm::Type *MemTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 5174 5175 if (IsIndirect) { 5176 // If it's been passed indirectly (actually a struct), whatever we find from 5177 // stored registers or on the stack will actually be a struct **. 5178 MemTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(MemTy); 5179 } 5180 5181 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5182 uint64_t NumMembers = 0; 5183 bool IsHFA = isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumMembers); 5184 if (IsHFA && NumMembers > 1) { 5185 // Homogeneous aggregates passed in registers will have their elements split 5186 // and stored 16-bytes apart regardless of size (they're notionally in qN, 5187 // qN+1, ...). We reload and store into a temporary local variable 5188 // contiguously. 5189 assert(!IsIndirect && "Homogeneous aggregates should be passed directly"); 5190 auto BaseTyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(QualType(Base, 0)); 5191 llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)); 5192 llvm::Type *HFATy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, NumMembers); 5193 Address Tmp = CGF.CreateTempAlloca(HFATy, 5194 std::max(TyAlign, BaseTyInfo.second)); 5195 5196 // On big-endian platforms, the value will be right-aligned in its slot. 5197 int Offset = 0; 5198 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && 5199 BaseTyInfo.first.getQuantity() < 16) 5200 Offset = 16 - BaseTyInfo.first.getQuantity(); 5201 5202 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumMembers; ++i) { 5203 CharUnits BaseOffset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16 * i + Offset); 5204 Address LoadAddr = 5205 CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(BaseAddr, BaseOffset); 5206 LoadAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(LoadAddr, BaseTy); 5207 5208 Address StoreAddr = 5209 CGF.Builder.CreateConstArrayGEP(Tmp, i, BaseTyInfo.first); 5210 5211 llvm::Value *Elem = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(LoadAddr); 5212 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(Elem, StoreAddr); 5213 } 5214 5215 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, MemTy); 5216 } else { 5217 // Otherwise the object is contiguous in memory. 5218 5219 // It might be right-aligned in its slot. 5220 CharUnits SlotSize = BaseAddr.getAlignment(); 5221 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && !IsIndirect && 5222 (IsHFA || !isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) && 5223 TyInfo.first < SlotSize) { 5224 CharUnits Offset = SlotSize - TyInfo.first; 5225 BaseAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(BaseAddr, Offset); 5226 } 5227 5228 RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(BaseAddr, MemTy); 5229 } 5230 5231 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 5232 5233 //======================================= 5234 // Argument was on the stack 5235 //======================================= 5236 CGF.EmitBlock(OnStackBlock); 5237 5238 Address stack_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 0, 5239 CharUnits::Zero(), "stack_p"); 5240 llvm::Value *OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(stack_p, "stack"); 5241 5242 // Again, stack arguments may need realignment. In this case both integer and 5243 // floating-point ones might be affected. 5244 if (!IsIndirect && TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) { 5245 int Align = TyAlign.getQuantity(); 5246 5247 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(OnStackPtr, CGF.Int64Ty); 5248 5249 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd( 5250 OnStackPtr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, Align - 1), 5251 "align_stack"); 5252 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd( 5253 OnStackPtr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, -Align), 5254 "align_stack"); 5255 5256 OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(OnStackPtr, CGF.Int8PtrTy); 5257 } 5258 Address OnStackAddr(OnStackPtr, 5259 std::max(CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), TyAlign)); 5260 5261 // All stack slots are multiples of 8 bytes. 5262 CharUnits StackSlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 5263 CharUnits StackSize; 5264 if (IsIndirect) 5265 StackSize = StackSlotSize; 5266 else 5267 StackSize = TyInfo.first.alignTo(StackSlotSize); 5268 5269 llvm::Value *StackSizeC = CGF.Builder.getSize(StackSize); 5270 llvm::Value *NewStack = 5271 CGF.Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(OnStackPtr, StackSizeC, "new_stack"); 5272 5273 // Write the new value of __stack for the next call to va_arg 5274 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewStack, stack_p); 5275 5276 if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && !isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && 5277 TyInfo.first < StackSlotSize) { 5278 CharUnits Offset = StackSlotSize - TyInfo.first; 5279 OnStackAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(OnStackAddr, Offset); 5280 } 5281 5282 OnStackAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OnStackAddr, MemTy); 5283 5284 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 5285 5286 //======================================= 5287 // Tidy up 5288 //======================================= 5289 CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock); 5290 5291 Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, 5292 OnStackAddr, OnStackBlock, "vaargs.addr"); 5293 5294 if (IsIndirect) 5295 return Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ResAddr, "vaarg.addr"), 5296 TyInfo.second); 5297 5298 return ResAddr; 5299 } 5300 5301 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitDarwinVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty, 5302 CodeGenFunction &CGF) const { 5303 // The backend's lowering doesn't support va_arg for aggregates or 5304 // illegal vector types. Lower VAArg here for these cases and use 5305 // the LLVM va_arg instruction for everything else. 5306 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) 5307 return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 5308 5309 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 5310 5311 // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes. 5312 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) { 5313 Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "ap.cur"), SlotSize); 5314 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty)); 5315 return Addr; 5316 } 5317 5318 // The size of the actual thing passed, which might end up just 5319 // being a pointer for indirect types. 5320 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 5321 5322 // Arguments bigger than 16 bytes which aren't homogeneous 5323 // aggregates should be passed indirectly. 5324 bool IsIndirect = false; 5325 if (TyInfo.first.getQuantity() > 16) { 5326 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5327 uint64_t Members = 0; 5328 IsIndirect = !isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members); 5329 } 5330 5331 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, 5332 TyInfo, SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 5333 } 5334 5335 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 5336 // ARM ABI Implementation 5337 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 5338 5339 namespace { 5340 5341 class ARMABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 5342 public: 5343 enum ABIKind { 5344 APCS = 0, 5345 AAPCS = 1, 5346 AAPCS_VFP = 2, 5347 AAPCS16_VFP = 3, 5348 }; 5349 5350 private: 5351 ABIKind Kind; 5352 5353 public: 5354 ARMABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind _Kind) 5355 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(_Kind) { 5356 setCCs(); 5357 } 5358 5359 bool isEABI() const { 5360 switch (getTarget().getTriple().getEnvironment()) { 5361 case llvm::Triple::Android: 5362 case llvm::Triple::EABI: 5363 case llvm::Triple::EABIHF: 5364 case llvm::Triple::GNUEABI: 5365 case llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF: 5366 case llvm::Triple::MuslEABI: 5367 case llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF: 5368 return true; 5369 default: 5370 return false; 5371 } 5372 } 5373 5374 bool isEABIHF() const { 5375 switch (getTarget().getTriple().getEnvironment()) { 5376 case llvm::Triple::EABIHF: 5377 case llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF: 5378 case llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF: 5379 return true; 5380 default: 5381 return false; 5382 } 5383 } 5384 5385 ABIKind getABIKind() const { return Kind; } 5386 5387 private: 5388 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic) const; 5389 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic) const; 5390 bool isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const; 5391 5392 bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override; 5393 bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty, 5394 uint64_t Members) const override; 5395 5396 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 5397 5398 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 5399 QualType Ty) const override; 5400 5401 llvm::CallingConv::ID getLLVMDefaultCC() const; 5402 llvm::CallingConv::ID getABIDefaultCC() const; 5403 void setCCs(); 5404 5405 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 5406 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 5407 bool asReturnValue) const override { 5408 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 5409 } 5410 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 5411 return true; 5412 } 5413 bool isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, llvm::Type *eltTy, 5414 unsigned elts) const override; 5415 }; 5416 5417 class ARMTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 5418 public: 5419 ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ARMABIInfo::ABIKind K) 5420 :TargetCodeGenInfo(new ARMABIInfo(CGT, K)) {} 5421 5422 const ARMABIInfo &getABIInfo() const { 5423 return static_cast<const ARMABIInfo&>(TargetCodeGenInfo::getABIInfo()); 5424 } 5425 5426 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 5427 return 13; 5428 } 5429 5430 StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override { 5431 return "mov\tr7, r7\t\t@ marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue"; 5432 } 5433 5434 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 5435 llvm::Value *Address) const override { 5436 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4); 5437 5438 // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers. 5439 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 15); 5440 return false; 5441 } 5442 5443 unsigned getSizeOfUnwindException() const override { 5444 if (getABIInfo().isEABI()) return 88; 5445 return TargetCodeGenInfo::getSizeOfUnwindException(); 5446 } 5447 5448 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 5449 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 5450 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 5451 if (!FD) 5452 return; 5453 5454 const ARMInterruptAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>(); 5455 if (!Attr) 5456 return; 5457 5458 const char *Kind; 5459 switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) { 5460 case ARMInterruptAttr::Generic: Kind = ""; break; 5461 case ARMInterruptAttr::IRQ: Kind = "IRQ"; break; 5462 case ARMInterruptAttr::FIQ: Kind = "FIQ"; break; 5463 case ARMInterruptAttr::SWI: Kind = "SWI"; break; 5464 case ARMInterruptAttr::ABORT: Kind = "ABORT"; break; 5465 case ARMInterruptAttr::UNDEF: Kind = "UNDEF"; break; 5466 } 5467 5468 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 5469 5470 Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind); 5471 5472 ARMABIInfo::ABIKind ABI = cast<ARMABIInfo>(getABIInfo()).getABIKind(); 5473 if (ABI == ARMABIInfo::APCS) 5474 return; 5475 5476 // AAPCS guarantees that sp will be 8-byte aligned on any public interface, 5477 // however this is not necessarily true on taking any interrupt. Instruct 5478 // the backend to perform a realignment as part of the function prologue. 5479 llvm::AttrBuilder B; 5480 B.addStackAlignmentAttr(8); 5481 Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B); 5482 } 5483 }; 5484 5485 class WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo : public ARMTargetCodeGenInfo { 5486 public: 5487 WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ARMABIInfo::ABIKind K) 5488 : ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, K) {} 5489 5490 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 5491 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override; 5492 5493 void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib, 5494 llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override { 5495 Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:" + qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib); 5496 } 5497 5498 void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, llvm::StringRef Value, 5499 llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override { 5500 Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\""; 5501 } 5502 }; 5503 5504 void WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 5505 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 5506 ARMTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM); 5507 addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(D, GV, CGM); 5508 } 5509 } 5510 5511 void ARMABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 5512 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 5513 FI.getReturnInfo() = 5514 classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), FI.isVariadic()); 5515 5516 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 5517 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, FI.isVariadic()); 5518 5519 // Always honor user-specified calling convention. 5520 if (FI.getCallingConvention() != llvm::CallingConv::C) 5521 return; 5522 5523 llvm::CallingConv::ID cc = getRuntimeCC(); 5524 if (cc != llvm::CallingConv::C) 5525 FI.setEffectiveCallingConvention(cc); 5526 } 5527 5528 /// Return the default calling convention that LLVM will use. 5529 llvm::CallingConv::ID ARMABIInfo::getLLVMDefaultCC() const { 5530 // The default calling convention that LLVM will infer. 5531 if (isEABIHF() || getTarget().getTriple().isWatchABI()) 5532 return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP; 5533 else if (isEABI()) 5534 return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS; 5535 else 5536 return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_APCS; 5537 } 5538 5539 /// Return the calling convention that our ABI would like us to use 5540 /// as the C calling convention. 5541 llvm::CallingConv::ID ARMABIInfo::getABIDefaultCC() const { 5542 switch (getABIKind()) { 5543 case APCS: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_APCS; 5544 case AAPCS: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS; 5545 case AAPCS_VFP: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP; 5546 case AAPCS16_VFP: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP; 5547 } 5548 llvm_unreachable("bad ABI kind"); 5549 } 5550 5551 void ARMABIInfo::setCCs() { 5552 assert(getRuntimeCC() == llvm::CallingConv::C); 5553 5554 // Don't muddy up the IR with a ton of explicit annotations if 5555 // they'd just match what LLVM will infer from the triple. 5556 llvm::CallingConv::ID abiCC = getABIDefaultCC(); 5557 if (abiCC != getLLVMDefaultCC()) 5558 RuntimeCC = abiCC; 5559 5560 // AAPCS apparently requires runtime support functions to be soft-float, but 5561 // that's almost certainly for historic reasons (Thumb1 not supporting VFP 5562 // most likely). It's more convenient for AAPCS16_VFP to be hard-float. 5563 switch (getABIKind()) { 5564 case APCS: 5565 case AAPCS16_VFP: 5566 if (abiCC != getLLVMDefaultCC()) 5567 BuiltinCC = abiCC; 5568 break; 5569 case AAPCS: 5570 case AAPCS_VFP: 5571 BuiltinCC = llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS; 5572 break; 5573 } 5574 } 5575 5576 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 5577 bool isVariadic) const { 5578 // 6.1.2.1 The following argument types are VFP CPRCs: 5579 // A single-precision floating-point type (including promoted 5580 // half-precision types); A double-precision floating-point type; 5581 // A 64-bit or 128-bit containerized vector type; Homogeneous Aggregate 5582 // with a Base Type of a single- or double-precision floating-point type, 5583 // 64-bit containerized vectors or 128-bit containerized vectors with one 5584 // to four Elements. 5585 bool IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP = getABIKind() == AAPCS_VFP && !isVariadic; 5586 5587 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 5588 5589 // Handle illegal vector types here. 5590 if (isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 5591 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 5592 if (Size <= 32) { 5593 llvm::Type *ResType = 5594 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5595 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5596 } 5597 if (Size == 64) { 5598 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::VectorType::get( 5599 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 2); 5600 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5601 } 5602 if (Size == 128) { 5603 llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::VectorType::get( 5604 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 4); 5605 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5606 } 5607 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 5608 } 5609 5610 // __fp16 gets passed as if it were an int or float, but with the top 16 bits 5611 // unspecified. This is not done for OpenCL as it handles the half type 5612 // natively, and does not need to interwork with AAPCS code. 5613 if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getContext().getLangOpts().NativeHalfArgsAndReturns) { 5614 llvm::Type *ResType = IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP ? 5615 llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()) : 5616 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5617 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5618 } 5619 5620 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 5621 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 5622 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) { 5623 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 5624 } 5625 5626 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend() 5627 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 5628 } 5629 5630 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) { 5631 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 5632 } 5633 5634 // Ignore empty records. 5635 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 5636 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5637 5638 if (IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP) { 5639 // Homogeneous Aggregates need to be expanded when we can fit the aggregate 5640 // into VFP registers. 5641 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5642 uint64_t Members = 0; 5643 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 5644 assert(Base && "Base class should be set for homogeneous aggregate"); 5645 // Base can be a floating-point or a vector. 5646 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false); 5647 } 5648 } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP) { 5649 // WatchOS does have homogeneous aggregates. Note that we intentionally use 5650 // this convention even for a variadic function: the backend will use GPRs 5651 // if needed. 5652 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5653 uint64_t Members = 0; 5654 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 5655 assert(Base && Members <= 4 && "unexpected homogeneous aggregate"); 5656 llvm::Type *Ty = 5657 llvm::ArrayType::get(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)), Members); 5658 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Ty, 0, nullptr, false); 5659 } 5660 } 5661 5662 if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && 5663 getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)) { 5664 // WatchOS is adopting the 64-bit AAPCS rule on composite types: if they're 5665 // bigger than 128-bits, they get placed in space allocated by the caller, 5666 // and a pointer is passed. 5667 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect( 5668 CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8), false); 5669 } 5670 5671 // Support byval for ARM. 5672 // The ABI alignment for APCS is 4-byte and for AAPCS at least 4-byte and at 5673 // most 8-byte. We realign the indirect argument if type alignment is bigger 5674 // than ABI alignment. 5675 uint64_t ABIAlign = 4; 5676 uint64_t TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 5677 if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP || 5678 getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS) 5679 ABIAlign = std::min(std::max(TyAlign, (uint64_t)4), (uint64_t)8); 5680 5681 if (getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(64)) { 5682 assert(getABIKind() != ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && "unexpected byval"); 5683 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(ABIAlign), 5684 /*ByVal=*/true, 5685 /*Realign=*/TyAlign > ABIAlign); 5686 } 5687 5688 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 64 bytes to an integer array of 5689 // same size and alignment. 5690 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 5691 return coerceToIntArray(Ty, getContext(), getVMContext()); 5692 } 5693 5694 // Otherwise, pass by coercing to a structure of the appropriate size. 5695 llvm::Type* ElemTy; 5696 unsigned SizeRegs; 5697 // FIXME: Try to match the types of the arguments more accurately where 5698 // we can. 5699 if (getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) <= 32) { 5700 ElemTy = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5701 SizeRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 5702 } else { 5703 ElemTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()); 5704 SizeRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 63) / 64; 5705 } 5706 5707 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(ElemTy, SizeRegs)); 5708 } 5709 5710 static bool isIntegerLikeType(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context, 5711 llvm::LLVMContext &VMContext) { 5712 // APCS, C Language Calling Conventions, Non-Simple Return Values: A structure 5713 // is called integer-like if its size is less than or equal to one word, and 5714 // the offset of each of its addressable sub-fields is zero. 5715 5716 uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty); 5717 5718 // Check that the type fits in a word. 5719 if (Size > 32) 5720 return false; 5721 5722 // FIXME: Handle vector types! 5723 if (Ty->isVectorType()) 5724 return false; 5725 5726 // Float types are never treated as "integer like". 5727 if (Ty->isRealFloatingType()) 5728 return false; 5729 5730 // If this is a builtin or pointer type then it is ok. 5731 if (Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() || Ty->isPointerType()) 5732 return true; 5733 5734 // Small complex integer types are "integer like". 5735 if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) 5736 return isIntegerLikeType(CT->getElementType(), Context, VMContext); 5737 5738 // Single element and zero sized arrays should be allowed, by the definition 5739 // above, but they are not. 5740 5741 // Otherwise, it must be a record type. 5742 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 5743 if (!RT) return false; 5744 5745 // Ignore records with flexible arrays. 5746 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 5747 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 5748 return false; 5749 5750 // Check that all sub-fields are at offset 0, and are themselves "integer 5751 // like". 5752 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD); 5753 5754 bool HadField = false; 5755 unsigned idx = 0; 5756 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 5757 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 5758 const FieldDecl *FD = *i; 5759 5760 // Bit-fields are not addressable, we only need to verify they are "integer 5761 // like". We still have to disallow a subsequent non-bitfield, for example: 5762 // struct { int : 0; int x } 5763 // is non-integer like according to gcc. 5764 if (FD->isBitField()) { 5765 if (!RD->isUnion()) 5766 HadField = true; 5767 5768 if (!isIntegerLikeType(FD->getType(), Context, VMContext)) 5769 return false; 5770 5771 continue; 5772 } 5773 5774 // Check if this field is at offset 0. 5775 if (Layout.getFieldOffset(idx) != 0) 5776 return false; 5777 5778 if (!isIntegerLikeType(FD->getType(), Context, VMContext)) 5779 return false; 5780 5781 // Only allow at most one field in a structure. This doesn't match the 5782 // wording above, but follows gcc in situations with a field following an 5783 // empty structure. 5784 if (!RD->isUnion()) { 5785 if (HadField) 5786 return false; 5787 5788 HadField = true; 5789 } 5790 } 5791 5792 return true; 5793 } 5794 5795 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, 5796 bool isVariadic) const { 5797 bool IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP = 5798 (getABIKind() == AAPCS_VFP || getABIKind() == AAPCS16_VFP) && !isVariadic; 5799 5800 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 5801 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5802 5803 // Large vector types should be returned via memory. 5804 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 128) { 5805 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 5806 } 5807 5808 // __fp16 gets returned as if it were an int or float, but with the top 16 5809 // bits unspecified. This is not done for OpenCL as it handles the half type 5810 // natively, and does not need to interwork with AAPCS code. 5811 if (RetTy->isHalfType() && !getContext().getLangOpts().NativeHalfArgsAndReturns) { 5812 llvm::Type *ResType = IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP ? 5813 llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()) : 5814 llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5815 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType); 5816 } 5817 5818 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 5819 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 5820 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 5821 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 5822 5823 return RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend() 5824 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 5825 } 5826 5827 // Are we following APCS? 5828 if (getABIKind() == APCS) { 5829 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, false)) 5830 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5831 5832 // Complex types are all returned as packed integers. 5833 // 5834 // FIXME: Consider using 2 x vector types if the back end handles them 5835 // correctly. 5836 if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 5837 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get( 5838 getVMContext(), getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy))); 5839 5840 // Integer like structures are returned in r0. 5841 if (isIntegerLikeType(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext())) { 5842 // Return in the smallest viable integer type. 5843 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 5844 if (Size <= 8) 5845 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 5846 if (Size <= 16) 5847 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 5848 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 5849 } 5850 5851 // Otherwise return in memory. 5852 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 5853 } 5854 5855 // Otherwise this is an AAPCS variant. 5856 5857 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 5858 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 5859 5860 // Check for homogeneous aggregates with AAPCS-VFP. 5861 if (IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP) { 5862 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5863 uint64_t Members = 0; 5864 if (isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) { 5865 assert(Base && "Base class should be set for homogeneous aggregate"); 5866 // Homogeneous Aggregates are returned directly. 5867 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false); 5868 } 5869 } 5870 5871 // Aggregates <= 4 bytes are returned in r0; other aggregates 5872 // are returned indirectly. 5873 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 5874 if (Size <= 32) { 5875 // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 4 bytes to an integer array of 5876 // same size and alignment. 5877 if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) { 5878 return coerceToIntArray(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext()); 5879 } 5880 if (getDataLayout().isBigEndian()) 5881 // Return in 32 bit integer integer type (as if loaded by LDR, AAPCS 5.4) 5882 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 5883 5884 // Return in the smallest viable integer type. 5885 if (Size <= 8) 5886 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 5887 if (Size <= 16) 5888 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 5889 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 5890 } else if (Size <= 128 && getABIKind() == AAPCS16_VFP) { 5891 llvm::Type *Int32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()); 5892 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = 5893 llvm::ArrayType::get(Int32Ty, llvm::alignTo(Size, 32) / 32); 5894 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 5895 } 5896 5897 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 5898 } 5899 5900 /// isIllegalVector - check whether Ty is an illegal vector type. 5901 bool ARMABIInfo::isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const { 5902 if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType> ()) { 5903 if (isAndroid()) { 5904 // Android shipped using Clang 3.1, which supported a slightly different 5905 // vector ABI. The primary differences were that 3-element vector types 5906 // were legal, and so were sub 32-bit vectors (i.e. <2 x i8>). This path 5907 // accepts that legacy behavior for Android only. 5908 // Check whether VT is legal. 5909 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 5910 // NumElements should be power of 2 or equal to 3. 5911 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements) && NumElements != 3) 5912 return true; 5913 } else { 5914 // Check whether VT is legal. 5915 unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements(); 5916 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 5917 // NumElements should be power of 2. 5918 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements)) 5919 return true; 5920 // Size should be greater than 32 bits. 5921 return Size <= 32; 5922 } 5923 } 5924 return false; 5925 } 5926 5927 bool ARMABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits vectorSize, 5928 llvm::Type *eltTy, 5929 unsigned numElts) const { 5930 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(numElts)) 5931 return false; 5932 unsigned size = getDataLayout().getTypeStoreSizeInBits(eltTy); 5933 if (size > 64) 5934 return false; 5935 if (vectorSize.getQuantity() != 8 && 5936 (vectorSize.getQuantity() != 16 || numElts == 1)) 5937 return false; 5938 return true; 5939 } 5940 5941 bool ARMABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const { 5942 // Homogeneous aggregates for AAPCS-VFP must have base types of float, 5943 // double, or 64-bit or 128-bit vectors. 5944 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 5945 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 5946 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double || 5947 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) 5948 return true; 5949 } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) { 5950 unsigned VecSize = getContext().getTypeSize(VT); 5951 if (VecSize == 64 || VecSize == 128) 5952 return true; 5953 } 5954 return false; 5955 } 5956 5957 bool ARMABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base, 5958 uint64_t Members) const { 5959 return Members <= 4; 5960 } 5961 5962 Address ARMABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 5963 QualType Ty) const { 5964 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 5965 5966 // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes. 5967 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) { 5968 Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize); 5969 Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty)); 5970 return Addr; 5971 } 5972 5973 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 5974 CharUnits TyAlignForABI = TyInfo.second; 5975 5976 // Use indirect if size of the illegal vector is bigger than 16 bytes. 5977 bool IsIndirect = false; 5978 const Type *Base = nullptr; 5979 uint64_t Members = 0; 5980 if (TyInfo.first > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16) && isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) { 5981 IsIndirect = true; 5982 5983 // ARMv7k passes structs bigger than 16 bytes indirectly, in space 5984 // allocated by the caller. 5985 } else if (TyInfo.first > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16) && 5986 getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && 5987 !isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) { 5988 IsIndirect = true; 5989 5990 // Otherwise, bound the type's ABI alignment. 5991 // The ABI alignment for 64-bit or 128-bit vectors is 8 for AAPCS and 4 for 5992 // APCS. For AAPCS, the ABI alignment is at least 4-byte and at most 8-byte. 5993 // Our callers should be prepared to handle an under-aligned address. 5994 } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP || 5995 getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS) { 5996 TyAlignForABI = std::max(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4)); 5997 TyAlignForABI = std::min(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)); 5998 } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP) { 5999 // ARMv7k allows type alignment up to 16 bytes. 6000 TyAlignForABI = std::max(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4)); 6001 TyAlignForABI = std::min(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)); 6002 } else { 6003 TyAlignForABI = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 6004 } 6005 TyInfo.second = TyAlignForABI; 6006 6007 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, TyInfo, 6008 SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 6009 } 6010 6011 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6012 // NVPTX ABI Implementation 6013 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6014 6015 namespace { 6016 6017 class NVPTXABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 6018 public: 6019 NVPTXABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 6020 6021 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 6022 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 6023 6024 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 6025 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6026 QualType Ty) const override; 6027 }; 6028 6029 class NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6030 public: 6031 NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6032 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new NVPTXABIInfo(CGT)) {} 6033 6034 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6035 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 6036 private: 6037 // Adds a NamedMDNode with F, Name, and Operand as operands, and adds the 6038 // resulting MDNode to the nvvm.annotations MDNode. 6039 static void addNVVMMetadata(llvm::Function *F, StringRef Name, int Operand); 6040 }; 6041 6042 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 6043 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 6044 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6045 6046 // note: this is different from default ABI 6047 if (!RetTy->isScalarType()) 6048 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6049 6050 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6051 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 6052 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6053 6054 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 6055 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6056 } 6057 6058 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6059 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6060 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 6061 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6062 6063 // Return aggregates type as indirect by value 6064 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) 6065 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /* byval */ true); 6066 6067 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 6068 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6069 } 6070 6071 void NVPTXABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 6072 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 6073 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 6074 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 6075 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 6076 6077 // Always honor user-specified calling convention. 6078 if (FI.getCallingConvention() != llvm::CallingConv::C) 6079 return; 6080 6081 FI.setEffectiveCallingConvention(getRuntimeCC()); 6082 } 6083 6084 Address NVPTXABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6085 QualType Ty) const { 6086 llvm_unreachable("NVPTX does not support varargs"); 6087 } 6088 6089 void NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo:: 6090 setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6091 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const{ 6092 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 6093 if (!FD) return; 6094 6095 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6096 6097 // Perform special handling in OpenCL mode 6098 if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 6099 // Use OpenCL function attributes to check for kernel functions 6100 // By default, all functions are device functions 6101 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 6102 // OpenCL __kernel functions get kernel metadata 6103 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"kernel", i32 1} node 6104 addNVVMMetadata(F, "kernel", 1); 6105 // And kernel functions are not subject to inlining 6106 F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline); 6107 } 6108 } 6109 6110 // Perform special handling in CUDA mode. 6111 if (M.getLangOpts().CUDA) { 6112 // CUDA __global__ functions get a kernel metadata entry. Since 6113 // __global__ functions cannot be called from the device, we do not 6114 // need to set the noinline attribute. 6115 if (FD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) { 6116 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"kernel", i32 1} node 6117 addNVVMMetadata(F, "kernel", 1); 6118 } 6119 if (CUDALaunchBoundsAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<CUDALaunchBoundsAttr>()) { 6120 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"maxntidx", i32 <val>} node 6121 llvm::APSInt MaxThreads(32); 6122 MaxThreads = Attr->getMaxThreads()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()); 6123 if (MaxThreads > 0) 6124 addNVVMMetadata(F, "maxntidx", MaxThreads.getExtValue()); 6125 6126 // min blocks is an optional argument for CUDALaunchBoundsAttr. If it was 6127 // not specified in __launch_bounds__ or if the user specified a 0 value, 6128 // we don't have to add a PTX directive. 6129 if (Attr->getMinBlocks()) { 6130 llvm::APSInt MinBlocks(32); 6131 MinBlocks = Attr->getMinBlocks()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()); 6132 if (MinBlocks > 0) 6133 // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"minctasm", i32 <val>} node 6134 addNVVMMetadata(F, "minctasm", MinBlocks.getExtValue()); 6135 } 6136 } 6137 } 6138 } 6139 6140 void NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo::addNVVMMetadata(llvm::Function *F, StringRef Name, 6141 int Operand) { 6142 llvm::Module *M = F->getParent(); 6143 llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = M->getContext(); 6144 6145 // Get "nvvm.annotations" metadata node 6146 llvm::NamedMDNode *MD = M->getOrInsertNamedMetadata("nvvm.annotations"); 6147 6148 llvm::Metadata *MDVals[] = { 6149 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(F), llvm::MDString::get(Ctx, Name), 6150 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get( 6151 llvm::ConstantInt::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(Ctx), Operand))}; 6152 // Append metadata to nvvm.annotations 6153 MD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, MDVals)); 6154 } 6155 } 6156 6157 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6158 // SystemZ ABI Implementation 6159 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6160 6161 namespace { 6162 6163 class SystemZABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo { 6164 bool HasVector; 6165 6166 public: 6167 SystemZABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool HV) 6168 : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), HasVector(HV) {} 6169 6170 bool isPromotableIntegerType(QualType Ty) const; 6171 bool isCompoundType(QualType Ty) const; 6172 bool isVectorArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 6173 bool isFPArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 6174 QualType GetSingleElementType(QualType Ty) const; 6175 6176 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 6177 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType ArgTy) const; 6178 6179 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 6180 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 6181 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 6182 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 6183 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 6184 } 6185 6186 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6187 QualType Ty) const override; 6188 6189 bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, 6190 ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars, 6191 bool asReturnValue) const override { 6192 return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4); 6193 } 6194 bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override { 6195 return true; 6196 } 6197 }; 6198 6199 class SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6200 public: 6201 SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool HasVector) 6202 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SystemZABIInfo(CGT, HasVector)) {} 6203 }; 6204 6205 } 6206 6207 bool SystemZABIInfo::isPromotableIntegerType(QualType Ty) const { 6208 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6209 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 6210 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6211 6212 // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI. 6213 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) 6214 return true; 6215 6216 // 32-bit values must also be promoted. 6217 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 6218 switch (BT->getKind()) { 6219 case BuiltinType::Int: 6220 case BuiltinType::UInt: 6221 return true; 6222 default: 6223 return false; 6224 } 6225 return false; 6226 } 6227 6228 bool SystemZABIInfo::isCompoundType(QualType Ty) const { 6229 return (Ty->isAnyComplexType() || 6230 Ty->isVectorType() || 6231 isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)); 6232 } 6233 6234 bool SystemZABIInfo::isVectorArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6235 return (HasVector && 6236 Ty->isVectorType() && 6237 getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 128); 6238 } 6239 6240 bool SystemZABIInfo::isFPArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6241 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 6242 switch (BT->getKind()) { 6243 case BuiltinType::Float: 6244 case BuiltinType::Double: 6245 return true; 6246 default: 6247 return false; 6248 } 6249 6250 return false; 6251 } 6252 6253 QualType SystemZABIInfo::GetSingleElementType(QualType Ty) const { 6254 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAsStructureType()) { 6255 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6256 QualType Found; 6257 6258 // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first. 6259 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) 6260 for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) { 6261 QualType Base = I.getType(); 6262 6263 // Empty bases don't affect things either way. 6264 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Base, true)) 6265 continue; 6266 6267 if (!Found.isNull()) 6268 return Ty; 6269 Found = GetSingleElementType(Base); 6270 } 6271 6272 // Check the fields. 6273 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 6274 // For compatibility with GCC, ignore empty bitfields in C++ mode. 6275 // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), empty structure and array fields 6276 // do count. So do anonymous bitfields that aren't zero-sized. 6277 if (getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6278 FD->isBitField() && FD->getBitWidthValue(getContext()) == 0) 6279 continue; 6280 6281 // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), arrays do not count. 6282 // Nested structures still do though. 6283 if (!Found.isNull()) 6284 return Ty; 6285 Found = GetSingleElementType(FD->getType()); 6286 } 6287 6288 // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), trailing padding is allowed. 6289 // An 8-byte aligned struct s { float f; } is passed as a double. 6290 if (!Found.isNull()) 6291 return Found; 6292 } 6293 6294 return Ty; 6295 } 6296 6297 Address SystemZABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6298 QualType Ty) const { 6299 // Assume that va_list type is correct; should be pointer to LLVM type: 6300 // struct { 6301 // i64 __gpr; 6302 // i64 __fpr; 6303 // i8 *__overflow_arg_area; 6304 // i8 *__reg_save_area; 6305 // }; 6306 6307 // Every non-vector argument occupies 8 bytes and is passed by preference 6308 // in either GPRs or FPRs. Vector arguments occupy 8 or 16 bytes and are 6309 // always passed on the stack. 6310 Ty = getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty); 6311 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 6312 llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty); 6313 llvm::Type *DirectTy = ArgTy; 6314 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty); 6315 bool IsIndirect = AI.isIndirect(); 6316 bool InFPRs = false; 6317 bool IsVector = false; 6318 CharUnits UnpaddedSize; 6319 CharUnits DirectAlign; 6320 if (IsIndirect) { 6321 DirectTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(DirectTy); 6322 UnpaddedSize = DirectAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 6323 } else { 6324 if (AI.getCoerceToType()) 6325 ArgTy = AI.getCoerceToType(); 6326 InFPRs = ArgTy->isFloatTy() || ArgTy->isDoubleTy(); 6327 IsVector = ArgTy->isVectorTy(); 6328 UnpaddedSize = TyInfo.first; 6329 DirectAlign = TyInfo.second; 6330 } 6331 CharUnits PaddedSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 6332 if (IsVector && UnpaddedSize > PaddedSize) 6333 PaddedSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16); 6334 assert((UnpaddedSize <= PaddedSize) && "Invalid argument size."); 6335 6336 CharUnits Padding = (PaddedSize - UnpaddedSize); 6337 6338 llvm::Type *IndexTy = CGF.Int64Ty; 6339 llvm::Value *PaddedSizeV = 6340 llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, PaddedSize.getQuantity()); 6341 6342 if (IsVector) { 6343 // Work out the address of a vector argument on the stack. 6344 // Vector arguments are always passed in the high bits of a 6345 // single (8 byte) or double (16 byte) stack slot. 6346 Address OverflowArgAreaPtr = 6347 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16), 6348 "overflow_arg_area_ptr"); 6349 Address OverflowArgArea = 6350 Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowArgAreaPtr, "overflow_arg_area"), 6351 TyInfo.second); 6352 Address MemAddr = 6353 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OverflowArgArea, DirectTy, "mem_addr"); 6354 6355 // Update overflow_arg_area_ptr pointer 6356 llvm::Value *NewOverflowArgArea = 6357 CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(OverflowArgArea.getPointer(), PaddedSizeV, 6358 "overflow_arg_area"); 6359 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOverflowArgArea, OverflowArgAreaPtr); 6360 6361 return MemAddr; 6362 } 6363 6364 assert(PaddedSize.getQuantity() == 8); 6365 6366 unsigned MaxRegs, RegCountField, RegSaveIndex; 6367 CharUnits RegPadding; 6368 if (InFPRs) { 6369 MaxRegs = 4; // Maximum of 4 FPR arguments 6370 RegCountField = 1; // __fpr 6371 RegSaveIndex = 16; // save offset for f0 6372 RegPadding = CharUnits(); // floats are passed in the high bits of an FPR 6373 } else { 6374 MaxRegs = 5; // Maximum of 5 GPR arguments 6375 RegCountField = 0; // __gpr 6376 RegSaveIndex = 2; // save offset for r2 6377 RegPadding = Padding; // values are passed in the low bits of a GPR 6378 } 6379 6380 Address RegCountPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP( 6381 VAListAddr, RegCountField, RegCountField * CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), 6382 "reg_count_ptr"); 6383 llvm::Value *RegCount = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RegCountPtr, "reg_count"); 6384 llvm::Value *MaxRegsV = llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, MaxRegs); 6385 llvm::Value *InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULT(RegCount, MaxRegsV, 6386 "fits_in_regs"); 6387 6388 llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg"); 6389 llvm::BasicBlock *InMemBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_mem"); 6390 llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end"); 6391 CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, InMemBlock); 6392 6393 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in registers. 6394 CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock); 6395 6396 // Work out the address of an argument register. 6397 llvm::Value *ScaledRegCount = 6398 CGF.Builder.CreateMul(RegCount, PaddedSizeV, "scaled_reg_count"); 6399 llvm::Value *RegBase = 6400 llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, RegSaveIndex * PaddedSize.getQuantity() 6401 + RegPadding.getQuantity()); 6402 llvm::Value *RegOffset = 6403 CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(ScaledRegCount, RegBase, "reg_offset"); 6404 Address RegSaveAreaPtr = 6405 CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(24), 6406 "reg_save_area_ptr"); 6407 llvm::Value *RegSaveArea = 6408 CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RegSaveAreaPtr, "reg_save_area"); 6409 Address RawRegAddr(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, RegOffset, 6410 "raw_reg_addr"), 6411 PaddedSize); 6412 Address RegAddr = 6413 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RawRegAddr, DirectTy, "reg_addr"); 6414 6415 // Update the register count 6416 llvm::Value *One = llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, 1); 6417 llvm::Value *NewRegCount = 6418 CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(RegCount, One, "reg_count"); 6419 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewRegCount, RegCountPtr); 6420 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 6421 6422 // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in memory. 6423 CGF.EmitBlock(InMemBlock); 6424 6425 // Work out the address of a stack argument. 6426 Address OverflowArgAreaPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP( 6427 VAListAddr, 2, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16), "overflow_arg_area_ptr"); 6428 Address OverflowArgArea = 6429 Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowArgAreaPtr, "overflow_arg_area"), 6430 PaddedSize); 6431 Address RawMemAddr = 6432 CGF.Builder.CreateConstByteGEP(OverflowArgArea, Padding, "raw_mem_addr"); 6433 Address MemAddr = 6434 CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RawMemAddr, DirectTy, "mem_addr"); 6435 6436 // Update overflow_arg_area_ptr pointer 6437 llvm::Value *NewOverflowArgArea = 6438 CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(OverflowArgArea.getPointer(), PaddedSizeV, 6439 "overflow_arg_area"); 6440 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOverflowArgArea, OverflowArgAreaPtr); 6441 CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock); 6442 6443 // Return the appropriate result. 6444 CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock); 6445 Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, 6446 MemAddr, InMemBlock, "va_arg.addr"); 6447 6448 if (IsIndirect) 6449 ResAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ResAddr, "indirect_arg"), 6450 TyInfo.second); 6451 6452 return ResAddr; 6453 } 6454 6455 ABIArgInfo SystemZABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 6456 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 6457 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6458 if (isVectorArgumentType(RetTy)) 6459 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6460 if (isCompoundType(RetTy) || getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 64) 6461 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 6462 return (isPromotableIntegerType(RetTy) ? 6463 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6464 } 6465 6466 ABIArgInfo SystemZABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 6467 // Handle the generic C++ ABI. 6468 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 6469 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 6470 6471 // Integers and enums are extended to full register width. 6472 if (isPromotableIntegerType(Ty)) 6473 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 6474 6475 // Handle vector types and vector-like structure types. Note that 6476 // as opposed to float-like structure types, we do not allow any 6477 // padding for vector-like structures, so verify the sizes match. 6478 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 6479 QualType SingleElementTy = GetSingleElementType(Ty); 6480 if (isVectorArgumentType(SingleElementTy) && 6481 getContext().getTypeSize(SingleElementTy) == Size) 6482 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(SingleElementTy)); 6483 6484 // Values that are not 1, 2, 4 or 8 bytes in size are passed indirectly. 6485 if (Size != 8 && Size != 16 && Size != 32 && Size != 64) 6486 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 6487 6488 // Handle small structures. 6489 if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) { 6490 // Structures with flexible arrays have variable length, so really 6491 // fail the size test above. 6492 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6493 if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 6494 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 6495 6496 // The structure is passed as an unextended integer, a float, or a double. 6497 llvm::Type *PassTy; 6498 if (isFPArgumentType(SingleElementTy)) { 6499 assert(Size == 32 || Size == 64); 6500 if (Size == 32) 6501 PassTy = llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()); 6502 else 6503 PassTy = llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()); 6504 } else 6505 PassTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size); 6506 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(PassTy); 6507 } 6508 6509 // Non-structure compounds are passed indirectly. 6510 if (isCompoundType(Ty)) 6511 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 6512 6513 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr); 6514 } 6515 6516 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6517 // MSP430 ABI Implementation 6518 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6519 6520 namespace { 6521 6522 class MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6523 public: 6524 MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6525 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {} 6526 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6527 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 6528 }; 6529 6530 } 6531 6532 void MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, 6533 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6534 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const { 6535 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 6536 if (const MSP430InterruptAttr *attr = FD->getAttr<MSP430InterruptAttr>()) { 6537 // Handle 'interrupt' attribute: 6538 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6539 6540 // Step 1: Set ISR calling convention. 6541 F->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::MSP430_INTR); 6542 6543 // Step 2: Add attributes goodness. 6544 F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline); 6545 6546 // Step 3: Emit ISR vector alias. 6547 unsigned Num = attr->getNumber() / 2; 6548 llvm::GlobalAlias::create(llvm::Function::ExternalLinkage, 6549 "__isr_" + Twine(Num), F); 6550 } 6551 } 6552 } 6553 6554 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6555 // MIPS ABI Implementation. This works for both little-endian and 6556 // big-endian variants. 6557 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6558 6559 namespace { 6560 class MipsABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 6561 bool IsO32; 6562 unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes, StackAlignInBytes; 6563 void CoerceToIntArgs(uint64_t TySize, 6564 SmallVectorImpl<llvm::Type *> &ArgList) const; 6565 llvm::Type* HandleAggregates(QualType Ty, uint64_t TySize) const; 6566 llvm::Type* returnAggregateInRegs(QualType RetTy, uint64_t Size) const; 6567 llvm::Type* getPaddingType(uint64_t Align, uint64_t Offset) const; 6568 public: 6569 MipsABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool _IsO32) : 6570 ABIInfo(CGT), IsO32(_IsO32), MinABIStackAlignInBytes(IsO32 ? 4 : 8), 6571 StackAlignInBytes(IsO32 ? 8 : 16) {} 6572 6573 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 6574 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, uint64_t &Offset) const; 6575 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 6576 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6577 QualType Ty) const override; 6578 bool shouldSignExtUnsignedType(QualType Ty) const override; 6579 }; 6580 6581 class MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6582 unsigned SizeOfUnwindException; 6583 public: 6584 MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool IsO32) 6585 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new MipsABIInfo(CGT, IsO32)), 6586 SizeOfUnwindException(IsO32 ? 24 : 32) {} 6587 6588 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 6589 return 29; 6590 } 6591 6592 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6593 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 6594 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 6595 if (!FD) return; 6596 llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6597 if (FD->hasAttr<Mips16Attr>()) { 6598 Fn->addFnAttr("mips16"); 6599 } 6600 else if (FD->hasAttr<NoMips16Attr>()) { 6601 Fn->addFnAttr("nomips16"); 6602 } 6603 6604 if (FD->hasAttr<MicroMipsAttr>()) 6605 Fn->addFnAttr("micromips"); 6606 else if (FD->hasAttr<NoMicroMipsAttr>()) 6607 Fn->addFnAttr("nomicromips"); 6608 6609 const MipsInterruptAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<MipsInterruptAttr>(); 6610 if (!Attr) 6611 return; 6612 6613 const char *Kind; 6614 switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) { 6615 case MipsInterruptAttr::eic: Kind = "eic"; break; 6616 case MipsInterruptAttr::sw0: Kind = "sw0"; break; 6617 case MipsInterruptAttr::sw1: Kind = "sw1"; break; 6618 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw0: Kind = "hw0"; break; 6619 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw1: Kind = "hw1"; break; 6620 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw2: Kind = "hw2"; break; 6621 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw3: Kind = "hw3"; break; 6622 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw4: Kind = "hw4"; break; 6623 case MipsInterruptAttr::hw5: Kind = "hw5"; break; 6624 } 6625 6626 Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind); 6627 6628 } 6629 6630 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 6631 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 6632 6633 unsigned getSizeOfUnwindException() const override { 6634 return SizeOfUnwindException; 6635 } 6636 }; 6637 } 6638 6639 void MipsABIInfo::CoerceToIntArgs( 6640 uint64_t TySize, SmallVectorImpl<llvm::Type *> &ArgList) const { 6641 llvm::IntegerType *IntTy = 6642 llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); 6643 6644 // Add (TySize / MinABIStackAlignInBytes) args of IntTy. 6645 for (unsigned N = TySize / (MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); N; --N) 6646 ArgList.push_back(IntTy); 6647 6648 // If necessary, add one more integer type to ArgList. 6649 unsigned R = TySize % (MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); 6650 6651 if (R) 6652 ArgList.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), R)); 6653 } 6654 6655 // In N32/64, an aligned double precision floating point field is passed in 6656 // a register. 6657 llvm::Type* MipsABIInfo::HandleAggregates(QualType Ty, uint64_t TySize) const { 6658 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> ArgList, IntArgList; 6659 6660 if (IsO32) { 6661 CoerceToIntArgs(TySize, ArgList); 6662 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList); 6663 } 6664 6665 if (Ty->isComplexType()) 6666 return CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 6667 6668 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 6669 6670 // Unions/vectors are passed in integer registers. 6671 if (!RT || !RT->isStructureOrClassType()) { 6672 CoerceToIntArgs(TySize, ArgList); 6673 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList); 6674 } 6675 6676 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6677 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD); 6678 assert(!(TySize % 8) && "Size of structure must be multiple of 8."); 6679 6680 uint64_t LastOffset = 0; 6681 unsigned idx = 0; 6682 llvm::IntegerType *I64 = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 64); 6683 6684 // Iterate over fields in the struct/class and check if there are any aligned 6685 // double fields. 6686 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 6687 i != e; ++i, ++idx) { 6688 const QualType Ty = i->getType(); 6689 const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 6690 6691 if (!BT || BT->getKind() != BuiltinType::Double) 6692 continue; 6693 6694 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(idx); 6695 if (Offset % 64) // Ignore doubles that are not aligned. 6696 continue; 6697 6698 // Add ((Offset - LastOffset) / 64) args of type i64. 6699 for (unsigned j = (Offset - LastOffset) / 64; j > 0; --j) 6700 ArgList.push_back(I64); 6701 6702 // Add double type. 6703 ArgList.push_back(llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext())); 6704 LastOffset = Offset + 64; 6705 } 6706 6707 CoerceToIntArgs(TySize - LastOffset, IntArgList); 6708 ArgList.append(IntArgList.begin(), IntArgList.end()); 6709 6710 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList); 6711 } 6712 6713 llvm::Type *MipsABIInfo::getPaddingType(uint64_t OrigOffset, 6714 uint64_t Offset) const { 6715 if (OrigOffset + MinABIStackAlignInBytes > Offset) 6716 return nullptr; 6717 6718 return llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), (Offset - OrigOffset) * 8); 6719 } 6720 6721 ABIArgInfo 6722 MipsABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, uint64_t &Offset) const { 6723 Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty); 6724 6725 uint64_t OrigOffset = Offset; 6726 uint64_t TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 6727 uint64_t Align = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 6728 6729 Align = std::min(std::max(Align, (uint64_t)MinABIStackAlignInBytes), 6730 (uint64_t)StackAlignInBytes); 6731 unsigned CurrOffset = llvm::alignTo(Offset, Align); 6732 Offset = CurrOffset + llvm::alignTo(TySize, Align * 8) / 8; 6733 6734 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) || Ty->isVectorType()) { 6735 // Ignore empty aggregates. 6736 if (TySize == 0) 6737 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6738 6739 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) { 6740 Offset = OrigOffset + MinABIStackAlignInBytes; 6741 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 6742 } 6743 6744 // Use indirect if the aggregate cannot fit into registers for 6745 // passing arguments according to the ABI 6746 unsigned Threshold = IsO32 ? 16 : 64; 6747 6748 if(getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(Threshold)) 6749 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align), true, 6750 getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8 > Align); 6751 6752 // If we have reached here, aggregates are passed directly by coercing to 6753 // another structure type. Padding is inserted if the offset of the 6754 // aggregate is unaligned. 6755 ABIArgInfo ArgInfo = 6756 ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HandleAggregates(Ty, TySize), 0, 6757 getPaddingType(OrigOffset, CurrOffset)); 6758 ArgInfo.setInReg(true); 6759 return ArgInfo; 6760 } 6761 6762 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6763 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 6764 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6765 6766 // All integral types are promoted to the GPR width. 6767 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 6768 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 6769 6770 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect( 6771 nullptr, 0, IsO32 ? nullptr : getPaddingType(OrigOffset, CurrOffset)); 6772 } 6773 6774 llvm::Type* 6775 MipsABIInfo::returnAggregateInRegs(QualType RetTy, uint64_t Size) const { 6776 const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>(); 6777 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> RTList; 6778 6779 if (RT && RT->isStructureOrClassType()) { 6780 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl(); 6781 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD); 6782 unsigned FieldCnt = Layout.getFieldCount(); 6783 6784 // N32/64 returns struct/classes in floating point registers if the 6785 // following conditions are met: 6786 // 1. The size of the struct/class is no larger than 128-bit. 6787 // 2. The struct/class has one or two fields all of which are floating 6788 // point types. 6789 // 3. The offset of the first field is zero (this follows what gcc does). 6790 // 6791 // Any other composite results are returned in integer registers. 6792 // 6793 if (FieldCnt && (FieldCnt <= 2) && !Layout.getFieldOffset(0)) { 6794 RecordDecl::field_iterator b = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end(); 6795 for (; b != e; ++b) { 6796 const BuiltinType *BT = b->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 6797 6798 if (!BT || !BT->isFloatingPoint()) 6799 break; 6800 6801 RTList.push_back(CGT.ConvertType(b->getType())); 6802 } 6803 6804 if (b == e) 6805 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), RTList, 6806 RD->hasAttr<PackedAttr>()); 6807 6808 RTList.clear(); 6809 } 6810 } 6811 6812 CoerceToIntArgs(Size, RTList); 6813 return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), RTList); 6814 } 6815 6816 ABIArgInfo MipsABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 6817 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 6818 6819 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 6820 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6821 6822 // O32 doesn't treat zero-sized structs differently from other structs. 6823 // However, N32/N64 ignores zero sized return values. 6824 if (!IsO32 && Size == 0) 6825 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 6826 6827 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy) || RetTy->isVectorType()) { 6828 if (Size <= 128) { 6829 if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType()) 6830 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 6831 6832 // O32 returns integer vectors in registers and N32/N64 returns all small 6833 // aggregates in registers. 6834 if (!IsO32 || 6835 (RetTy->isVectorType() && !RetTy->hasFloatingRepresentation())) { 6836 ABIArgInfo ArgInfo = 6837 ABIArgInfo::getDirect(returnAggregateInRegs(RetTy, Size)); 6838 ArgInfo.setInReg(true); 6839 return ArgInfo; 6840 } 6841 } 6842 6843 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 6844 } 6845 6846 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 6847 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 6848 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 6849 6850 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 6851 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 6852 } 6853 6854 void MipsABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 6855 ABIArgInfo &RetInfo = FI.getReturnInfo(); 6856 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 6857 RetInfo = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 6858 6859 // Check if a pointer to an aggregate is passed as a hidden argument. 6860 uint64_t Offset = RetInfo.isIndirect() ? MinABIStackAlignInBytes : 0; 6861 6862 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 6863 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, Offset); 6864 } 6865 6866 Address MipsABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 6867 QualType OrigTy) const { 6868 QualType Ty = OrigTy; 6869 6870 // Integer arguments are promoted to 32-bit on O32 and 64-bit on N32/N64. 6871 // Pointers are also promoted in the same way but this only matters for N32. 6872 unsigned SlotSizeInBits = IsO32 ? 32 : 64; 6873 unsigned PtrWidth = getTarget().getPointerWidth(0); 6874 bool DidPromote = false; 6875 if ((Ty->isIntegerType() && 6876 getContext().getIntWidth(Ty) < SlotSizeInBits) || 6877 (Ty->isPointerType() && PtrWidth < SlotSizeInBits)) { 6878 DidPromote = true; 6879 Ty = getContext().getIntTypeForBitwidth(SlotSizeInBits, 6880 Ty->isSignedIntegerType()); 6881 } 6882 6883 auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 6884 6885 // The alignment of things in the argument area is never larger than 6886 // StackAlignInBytes. 6887 TyInfo.second = 6888 std::min(TyInfo.second, CharUnits::fromQuantity(StackAlignInBytes)); 6889 6890 // MinABIStackAlignInBytes is the size of argument slots on the stack. 6891 CharUnits ArgSlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(MinABIStackAlignInBytes); 6892 6893 Address Addr = emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 6894 TyInfo, ArgSlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 6895 6896 6897 // If there was a promotion, "unpromote" into a temporary. 6898 // TODO: can we just use a pointer into a subset of the original slot? 6899 if (DidPromote) { 6900 Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(OrigTy, "vaarg.promotion-temp"); 6901 llvm::Value *Promoted = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(Addr); 6902 6903 // Truncate down to the right width. 6904 llvm::Type *IntTy = (OrigTy->isIntegerType() ? Temp.getElementType() 6905 : CGF.IntPtrTy); 6906 llvm::Value *V = CGF.Builder.CreateTrunc(Promoted, IntTy); 6907 if (OrigTy->isPointerType()) 6908 V = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(V, Temp.getElementType()); 6909 6910 CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, Temp); 6911 Addr = Temp; 6912 } 6913 6914 return Addr; 6915 } 6916 6917 bool MipsABIInfo::shouldSignExtUnsignedType(QualType Ty) const { 6918 int TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 6919 6920 // MIPS64 ABI requires unsigned 32 bit integers to be sign extended. 6921 if (Ty->isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() && TySize == 32) 6922 return true; 6923 6924 return false; 6925 } 6926 6927 bool 6928 MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 6929 llvm::Value *Address) const { 6930 // This information comes from gcc's implementation, which seems to 6931 // as canonical as it gets. 6932 6933 // Everything on MIPS is 4 bytes. Double-precision FP registers 6934 // are aliased to pairs of single-precision FP registers. 6935 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4); 6936 6937 // 0-31 are the general purpose registers, $0 - $31. 6938 // 32-63 are the floating-point registers, $f0 - $f31. 6939 // 64 and 65 are the multiply/divide registers, $hi and $lo. 6940 // 66 is the (notional, I think) register for signal-handler return. 6941 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 65); 6942 6943 // 67-74 are the floating-point status registers, $fcc0 - $fcc7. 6944 // They are one bit wide and ignored here. 6945 6946 // 80-111 are the coprocessor 0 registers, $c0r0 - $c0r31. 6947 // (coprocessor 1 is the FP unit) 6948 // 112-143 are the coprocessor 2 registers, $c2r0 - $c2r31. 6949 // 144-175 are the coprocessor 3 registers, $c3r0 - $c3r31. 6950 // 176-181 are the DSP accumulator registers. 6951 AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 80, 181); 6952 return false; 6953 } 6954 6955 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6956 // AVR ABI Implementation. 6957 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6958 6959 namespace { 6960 class AVRTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 6961 public: 6962 AVRTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6963 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) { } 6964 6965 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6966 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override { 6967 const auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 6968 if (!FD) return; 6969 auto *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 6970 6971 if (FD->getAttr<AVRInterruptAttr>()) 6972 Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt"); 6973 6974 if (FD->getAttr<AVRSignalAttr>()) 6975 Fn->addFnAttr("signal"); 6976 } 6977 }; 6978 } 6979 6980 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6981 // TCE ABI Implementation (see http://tce.cs.tut.fi). Uses mostly the defaults. 6982 // Currently subclassed only to implement custom OpenCL C function attribute 6983 // handling. 6984 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 6985 6986 namespace { 6987 6988 class TCETargetCodeGenInfo : public DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo { 6989 public: 6990 TCETargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 6991 : DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT) {} 6992 6993 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 6994 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 6995 }; 6996 6997 void TCETargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 6998 const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const { 6999 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 7000 if (!FD) return; 7001 7002 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 7003 7004 if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7005 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 7006 // OpenCL C Kernel functions are not subject to inlining 7007 F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline); 7008 const ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr>(); 7009 if (Attr) { 7010 // Convert the reqd_work_group_size() attributes to metadata. 7011 llvm::LLVMContext &Context = F->getContext(); 7012 llvm::NamedMDNode *OpenCLMetadata = 7013 M.getModule().getOrInsertNamedMetadata( 7014 "opencl.kernel_wg_size_info"); 7015 7016 SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 5> Operands; 7017 Operands.push_back(llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(F)); 7018 7019 Operands.push_back( 7020 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue( 7021 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getXDim())))); 7022 Operands.push_back( 7023 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue( 7024 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getYDim())))); 7025 Operands.push_back( 7026 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue( 7027 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getZDim())))); 7028 7029 // Add a boolean constant operand for "required" (true) or "hint" 7030 // (false) for implementing the work_group_size_hint attr later. 7031 // Currently always true as the hint is not yet implemented. 7032 Operands.push_back( 7033 llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::ConstantInt::getTrue(Context))); 7034 OpenCLMetadata->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Context, Operands)); 7035 } 7036 } 7037 } 7038 } 7039 7040 } 7041 7042 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7043 // Hexagon ABI Implementation 7044 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7045 7046 namespace { 7047 7048 class HexagonABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 7049 7050 7051 public: 7052 HexagonABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 7053 7054 private: 7055 7056 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 7057 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const; 7058 7059 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 7060 7061 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7062 QualType Ty) const override; 7063 }; 7064 7065 class HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7066 public: 7067 HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7068 :TargetCodeGenInfo(new HexagonABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7069 7070 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 7071 return 29; 7072 } 7073 }; 7074 7075 } 7076 7077 void HexagonABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 7078 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 7079 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 7080 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 7081 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type); 7082 } 7083 7084 ABIArgInfo HexagonABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 7085 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 7086 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 7087 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 7088 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7089 7090 return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 7091 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 7092 } 7093 7094 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 7095 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 7096 7097 // Ignore empty records. 7098 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 7099 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7100 7101 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 7102 if (Size > 64) 7103 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true); 7104 // Pass in the smallest viable integer type. 7105 else if (Size > 32) 7106 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext())); 7107 else if (Size > 16) 7108 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 7109 else if (Size > 8) 7110 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 7111 else 7112 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 7113 } 7114 7115 ABIArgInfo HexagonABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const { 7116 if (RetTy->isVoidType()) 7117 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7118 7119 // Large vector types should be returned via memory. 7120 if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 64) 7121 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy); 7122 7123 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) { 7124 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 7125 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>()) 7126 RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7127 7128 return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? 7129 ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect()); 7130 } 7131 7132 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true)) 7133 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7134 7135 // Aggregates <= 8 bytes are returned in r0; other aggregates 7136 // are returned indirectly. 7137 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy); 7138 if (Size <= 64) { 7139 // Return in the smallest viable integer type. 7140 if (Size <= 8) 7141 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext())); 7142 if (Size <= 16) 7143 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext())); 7144 if (Size <= 32) 7145 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext())); 7146 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext())); 7147 } 7148 7149 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/true); 7150 } 7151 7152 Address HexagonABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7153 QualType Ty) const { 7154 // FIXME: Someone needs to audit that this handle alignment correctly. 7155 return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false, 7156 getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty), 7157 CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), 7158 /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true); 7159 } 7160 7161 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7162 // Lanai ABI Implementation 7163 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7164 7165 namespace { 7166 class LanaiABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 7167 public: 7168 LanaiABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 7169 7170 bool shouldUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const; 7171 7172 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override { 7173 CCState State(FI.getCallingConvention()); 7174 // Lanai uses 4 registers to pass arguments unless the function has the 7175 // regparm attribute set. 7176 if (FI.getHasRegParm()) { 7177 State.FreeRegs = FI.getRegParm(); 7178 } else { 7179 State.FreeRegs = 4; 7180 } 7181 7182 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 7183 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 7184 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 7185 I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State); 7186 } 7187 7188 ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, CCState &State) const; 7189 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const; 7190 }; 7191 } // end anonymous namespace 7192 7193 bool LanaiABIInfo::shouldUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const { 7194 unsigned Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 7195 unsigned SizeInRegs = llvm::alignTo(Size, 32U) / 32U; 7196 7197 if (SizeInRegs == 0) 7198 return false; 7199 7200 if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs) { 7201 State.FreeRegs = 0; 7202 return false; 7203 } 7204 7205 State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs; 7206 7207 return true; 7208 } 7209 7210 ABIArgInfo LanaiABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, 7211 CCState &State) const { 7212 if (!ByVal) { 7213 if (State.FreeRegs) { 7214 --State.FreeRegs; // Non-byval indirects just use one pointer. 7215 return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty); 7216 } 7217 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false); 7218 } 7219 7220 // Compute the byval alignment. 7221 const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4; 7222 unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8; 7223 return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true, 7224 /*Realign=*/TypeAlign > 7225 MinABIStackAlignInBytes); 7226 } 7227 7228 ABIArgInfo LanaiABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, 7229 CCState &State) const { 7230 // Check with the C++ ABI first. 7231 const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 7232 if (RT) { 7233 CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()); 7234 if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) { 7235 return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State); 7236 } else if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) { 7237 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByRef=*/true); 7238 } 7239 } 7240 7241 if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) { 7242 // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect. 7243 if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) 7244 return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true, State); 7245 7246 // Ignore empty structs/unions. 7247 if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) 7248 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7249 7250 llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext(); 7251 unsigned SizeInRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32; 7252 if (SizeInRegs <= State.FreeRegs) { 7253 llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext); 7254 SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32); 7255 llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements); 7256 State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs; 7257 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result); 7258 } else { 7259 State.FreeRegs = 0; 7260 } 7261 return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State); 7262 } 7263 7264 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 7265 if (const auto *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 7266 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7267 7268 bool InReg = shouldUseInReg(Ty, State); 7269 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 7270 if (InReg) 7271 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(); 7272 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 7273 } 7274 if (InReg) 7275 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(); 7276 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7277 } 7278 7279 namespace { 7280 class LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7281 public: 7282 LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7283 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new LanaiABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7284 }; 7285 } 7286 7287 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7288 // AMDGPU ABI Implementation 7289 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7290 7291 namespace { 7292 7293 class AMDGPUABIInfo final : public DefaultABIInfo { 7294 public: 7295 explicit AMDGPUABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 7296 7297 private: 7298 ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const; 7299 7300 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 7301 }; 7302 7303 void AMDGPUABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 7304 if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) 7305 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 7306 7307 unsigned CC = FI.getCallingConvention(); 7308 for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments()) 7309 if (CC == llvm::CallingConv::AMDGPU_KERNEL) 7310 Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type); 7311 else 7312 Arg.info = DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Arg.type); 7313 } 7314 7315 /// \brief Classify argument of given type \p Ty. 7316 ABIArgInfo AMDGPUABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const { 7317 llvm::StructType *StrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(CGT.ConvertType(Ty)); 7318 if (!StrTy) { 7319 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty); 7320 } 7321 7322 // Coerce single element structs to its element. 7323 if (StrTy->getNumElements() == 1) { 7324 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7325 } 7326 7327 // If we set CanBeFlattened to true, CodeGen will expand the struct to its 7328 // individual elements, which confuses the Clover OpenCL backend; therefore we 7329 // have to set it to false here. Other args of getDirect() are just defaults. 7330 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false); 7331 } 7332 7333 class AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7334 public: 7335 AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7336 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new AMDGPUABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7337 void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 7338 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 7339 unsigned getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const override; 7340 7341 llvm::Constant *getNullPointer(const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 7342 llvm::PointerType *T, QualType QT) const override; 7343 7344 unsigned getASTAllocaAddressSpace() const override { 7345 return LangAS::FirstTargetAddressSpace + 7346 getABIInfo().getDataLayout().getAllocaAddrSpace(); 7347 } 7348 unsigned getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM, 7349 const VarDecl *D) const override; 7350 }; 7351 } 7352 7353 void AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes( 7354 const Decl *D, 7355 llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 7356 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const { 7357 const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D); 7358 if (!FD) 7359 return; 7360 7361 llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV); 7362 7363 const auto *ReqdWGS = M.getLangOpts().OpenCL ? 7364 FD->getAttr<ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr>() : nullptr; 7365 const auto *FlatWGS = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUFlatWorkGroupSizeAttr>(); 7366 if (ReqdWGS || FlatWGS) { 7367 unsigned Min = FlatWGS ? FlatWGS->getMin() : 0; 7368 unsigned Max = FlatWGS ? FlatWGS->getMax() : 0; 7369 if (ReqdWGS && Min == 0 && Max == 0) 7370 Min = Max = ReqdWGS->getXDim() * ReqdWGS->getYDim() * ReqdWGS->getZDim(); 7371 7372 if (Min != 0) { 7373 assert(Min <= Max && "Min must be less than or equal Max"); 7374 7375 std::string AttrVal = llvm::utostr(Min) + "," + llvm::utostr(Max); 7376 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-flat-work-group-size", AttrVal); 7377 } else 7378 assert(Max == 0 && "Max must be zero"); 7379 } 7380 7381 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUWavesPerEUAttr>()) { 7382 unsigned Min = Attr->getMin(); 7383 unsigned Max = Attr->getMax(); 7384 7385 if (Min != 0) { 7386 assert((Max == 0 || Min <= Max) && "Min must be less than or equal Max"); 7387 7388 std::string AttrVal = llvm::utostr(Min); 7389 if (Max != 0) 7390 AttrVal = AttrVal + "," + llvm::utostr(Max); 7391 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-waves-per-eu", AttrVal); 7392 } else 7393 assert(Max == 0 && "Max must be zero"); 7394 } 7395 7396 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUNumSGPRAttr>()) { 7397 unsigned NumSGPR = Attr->getNumSGPR(); 7398 7399 if (NumSGPR != 0) 7400 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-num-sgpr", llvm::utostr(NumSGPR)); 7401 } 7402 7403 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUNumVGPRAttr>()) { 7404 uint32_t NumVGPR = Attr->getNumVGPR(); 7405 7406 if (NumVGPR != 0) 7407 F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-num-vgpr", llvm::utostr(NumVGPR)); 7408 } 7409 } 7410 7411 unsigned AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const { 7412 return llvm::CallingConv::AMDGPU_KERNEL; 7413 } 7414 7415 // Currently LLVM assumes null pointers always have value 0, 7416 // which results in incorrectly transformed IR. Therefore, instead of 7417 // emitting null pointers in private and local address spaces, a null 7418 // pointer in generic address space is emitted which is casted to a 7419 // pointer in local or private address space. 7420 llvm::Constant *AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getNullPointer( 7421 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, llvm::PointerType *PT, 7422 QualType QT) const { 7423 if (CGM.getContext().getTargetNullPointerValue(QT) == 0) 7424 return llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(PT); 7425 7426 auto &Ctx = CGM.getContext(); 7427 auto NPT = llvm::PointerType::get(PT->getElementType(), 7428 Ctx.getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_generic)); 7429 return llvm::ConstantExpr::getAddrSpaceCast( 7430 llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(NPT), PT); 7431 } 7432 7433 unsigned 7434 AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM, 7435 const VarDecl *D) const { 7436 assert(!CGM.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 7437 !(CGM.getLangOpts().CUDA && CGM.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) && 7438 "Address space agnostic languages only"); 7439 unsigned DefaultGlobalAS = 7440 LangAS::FirstTargetAddressSpace + 7441 CGM.getContext().getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global); 7442 if (!D) 7443 return DefaultGlobalAS; 7444 7445 unsigned AddrSpace = D->getType().getAddressSpace(); 7446 assert(AddrSpace == LangAS::Default || 7447 AddrSpace >= LangAS::FirstTargetAddressSpace); 7448 if (AddrSpace != LangAS::Default) 7449 return AddrSpace; 7450 7451 if (CGM.isTypeConstant(D->getType(), false)) { 7452 if (auto ConstAS = CGM.getTarget().getConstantAddressSpace()) 7453 return ConstAS.getValue(); 7454 } 7455 return DefaultGlobalAS; 7456 } 7457 7458 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7459 // SPARC v8 ABI Implementation. 7460 // Based on the SPARC Compliance Definition version 2.4.1. 7461 // 7462 // Ensures that complex values are passed in registers. 7463 // 7464 namespace { 7465 class SparcV8ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 7466 public: 7467 SparcV8ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 7468 7469 private: 7470 ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const; 7471 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 7472 }; 7473 } // end anonymous namespace 7474 7475 7476 ABIArgInfo 7477 SparcV8ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType Ty) const { 7478 if (Ty->isAnyComplexType()) { 7479 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7480 } 7481 else { 7482 return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(Ty); 7483 } 7484 } 7485 7486 void SparcV8ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 7487 7488 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType()); 7489 for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments()) 7490 Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type); 7491 } 7492 7493 namespace { 7494 class SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7495 public: 7496 SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7497 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SparcV8ABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7498 }; 7499 } // end anonymous namespace 7500 7501 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7502 // SPARC v9 ABI Implementation. 7503 // Based on the SPARC Compliance Definition version 2.4.1. 7504 // 7505 // Function arguments a mapped to a nominal "parameter array" and promoted to 7506 // registers depending on their type. Each argument occupies 8 or 16 bytes in 7507 // the array, structs larger than 16 bytes are passed indirectly. 7508 // 7509 // One case requires special care: 7510 // 7511 // struct mixed { 7512 // int i; 7513 // float f; 7514 // }; 7515 // 7516 // When a struct mixed is passed by value, it only occupies 8 bytes in the 7517 // parameter array, but the int is passed in an integer register, and the float 7518 // is passed in a floating point register. This is represented as two arguments 7519 // with the LLVM IR inreg attribute: 7520 // 7521 // declare void f(i32 inreg %i, float inreg %f) 7522 // 7523 // The code generator will only allocate 4 bytes from the parameter array for 7524 // the inreg arguments. All other arguments are allocated a multiple of 8 7525 // bytes. 7526 // 7527 namespace { 7528 class SparcV9ABIInfo : public ABIInfo { 7529 public: 7530 SparcV9ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {} 7531 7532 private: 7533 ABIArgInfo classifyType(QualType RetTy, unsigned SizeLimit) const; 7534 void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override; 7535 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7536 QualType Ty) const override; 7537 7538 // Coercion type builder for structs passed in registers. The coercion type 7539 // serves two purposes: 7540 // 7541 // 1. Pad structs to a multiple of 64 bits, so they are passed 'left-aligned' 7542 // in registers. 7543 // 2. Expose aligned floating point elements as first-level elements, so the 7544 // code generator knows to pass them in floating point registers. 7545 // 7546 // We also compute the InReg flag which indicates that the struct contains 7547 // aligned 32-bit floats. 7548 // 7549 struct CoerceBuilder { 7550 llvm::LLVMContext &Context; 7551 const llvm::DataLayout &DL; 7552 SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> Elems; 7553 uint64_t Size; 7554 bool InReg; 7555 7556 CoerceBuilder(llvm::LLVMContext &c, const llvm::DataLayout &dl) 7557 : Context(c), DL(dl), Size(0), InReg(false) {} 7558 7559 // Pad Elems with integers until Size is ToSize. 7560 void pad(uint64_t ToSize) { 7561 assert(ToSize >= Size && "Cannot remove elements"); 7562 if (ToSize == Size) 7563 return; 7564 7565 // Finish the current 64-bit word. 7566 uint64_t Aligned = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64); 7567 if (Aligned > Size && Aligned <= ToSize) { 7568 Elems.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(Context, Aligned - Size)); 7569 Size = Aligned; 7570 } 7571 7572 // Add whole 64-bit words. 7573 while (Size + 64 <= ToSize) { 7574 Elems.push_back(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(Context)); 7575 Size += 64; 7576 } 7577 7578 // Final in-word padding. 7579 if (Size < ToSize) { 7580 Elems.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(Context, ToSize - Size)); 7581 Size = ToSize; 7582 } 7583 } 7584 7585 // Add a floating point element at Offset. 7586 void addFloat(uint64_t Offset, llvm::Type *Ty, unsigned Bits) { 7587 // Unaligned floats are treated as integers. 7588 if (Offset % Bits) 7589 return; 7590 // The InReg flag is only required if there are any floats < 64 bits. 7591 if (Bits < 64) 7592 InReg = true; 7593 pad(Offset); 7594 Elems.push_back(Ty); 7595 Size = Offset + Bits; 7596 } 7597 7598 // Add a struct type to the coercion type, starting at Offset (in bits). 7599 void addStruct(uint64_t Offset, llvm::StructType *StrTy) { 7600 const llvm::StructLayout *Layout = DL.getStructLayout(StrTy); 7601 for (unsigned i = 0, e = StrTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) { 7602 llvm::Type *ElemTy = StrTy->getElementType(i); 7603 uint64_t ElemOffset = Offset + Layout->getElementOffsetInBits(i); 7604 switch (ElemTy->getTypeID()) { 7605 case llvm::Type::StructTyID: 7606 addStruct(ElemOffset, cast<llvm::StructType>(ElemTy)); 7607 break; 7608 case llvm::Type::FloatTyID: 7609 addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 32); 7610 break; 7611 case llvm::Type::DoubleTyID: 7612 addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 64); 7613 break; 7614 case llvm::Type::FP128TyID: 7615 addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 128); 7616 break; 7617 case llvm::Type::PointerTyID: 7618 if (ElemOffset % 64 == 0) { 7619 pad(ElemOffset); 7620 Elems.push_back(ElemTy); 7621 Size += 64; 7622 } 7623 break; 7624 default: 7625 break; 7626 } 7627 } 7628 } 7629 7630 // Check if Ty is a usable substitute for the coercion type. 7631 bool isUsableType(llvm::StructType *Ty) const { 7632 return llvm::makeArrayRef(Elems) == Ty->elements(); 7633 } 7634 7635 // Get the coercion type as a literal struct type. 7636 llvm::Type *getType() const { 7637 if (Elems.size() == 1) 7638 return Elems.front(); 7639 else 7640 return llvm::StructType::get(Context, Elems); 7641 } 7642 }; 7643 }; 7644 } // end anonymous namespace 7645 7646 ABIArgInfo 7647 SparcV9ABIInfo::classifyType(QualType Ty, unsigned SizeLimit) const { 7648 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 7649 return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore(); 7650 7651 uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty); 7652 7653 // Anything too big to fit in registers is passed with an explicit indirect 7654 // pointer / sret pointer. 7655 if (Size > SizeLimit) 7656 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false); 7657 7658 // Treat an enum type as its underlying type. 7659 if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) 7660 Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 7661 7662 // Integer types smaller than a register are extended. 7663 if (Size < 64 && Ty->isIntegerType()) 7664 return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(); 7665 7666 // Other non-aggregates go in registers. 7667 if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) 7668 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7669 7670 // If a C++ object has either a non-trivial copy constructor or a non-trivial 7671 // destructor, it is passed with an explicit indirect pointer / sret pointer. 7672 if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) 7673 return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory); 7674 7675 // This is a small aggregate type that should be passed in registers. 7676 // Build a coercion type from the LLVM struct type. 7677 llvm::StructType *StrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(CGT.ConvertType(Ty)); 7678 if (!StrTy) 7679 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(); 7680 7681 CoerceBuilder CB(getVMContext(), getDataLayout()); 7682 CB.addStruct(0, StrTy); 7683 CB.pad(llvm::alignTo(CB.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StrTy), 64)); 7684 7685 // Try to use the original type for coercion. 7686 llvm::Type *CoerceTy = CB.isUsableType(StrTy) ? StrTy : CB.getType(); 7687 7688 if (CB.InReg) 7689 return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(CoerceTy); 7690 else 7691 return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy); 7692 } 7693 7694 Address SparcV9ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7695 QualType Ty) const { 7696 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyType(Ty, 16 * 8); 7697 llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 7698 if (AI.canHaveCoerceToType() && !AI.getCoerceToType()) 7699 AI.setCoerceToType(ArgTy); 7700 7701 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8); 7702 7703 CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 7704 Address Addr(Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "ap.cur"), SlotSize); 7705 llvm::Type *ArgPtrTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(ArgTy); 7706 7707 auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty); 7708 7709 Address ArgAddr = Address::invalid(); 7710 CharUnits Stride; 7711 switch (AI.getKind()) { 7712 case ABIArgInfo::Expand: 7713 case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand: 7714 case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca: 7715 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI kind for va_arg"); 7716 7717 case ABIArgInfo::Extend: { 7718 Stride = SlotSize; 7719 CharUnits Offset = SlotSize - TypeInfo.first; 7720 ArgAddr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, Offset, "extend"); 7721 break; 7722 } 7723 7724 case ABIArgInfo::Direct: { 7725 auto AllocSize = getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AI.getCoerceToType()); 7726 Stride = CharUnits::fromQuantity(AllocSize).alignTo(SlotSize); 7727 ArgAddr = Addr; 7728 break; 7729 } 7730 7731 case ABIArgInfo::Indirect: 7732 Stride = SlotSize; 7733 ArgAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, ArgPtrTy, "indirect"); 7734 ArgAddr = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(ArgAddr, "indirect.arg"), 7735 TypeInfo.second); 7736 break; 7737 7738 case ABIArgInfo::Ignore: 7739 return Address(llvm::UndefValue::get(ArgPtrTy), TypeInfo.second); 7740 } 7741 7742 // Update VAList. 7743 llvm::Value *NextPtr = 7744 Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr.getPointer(), Stride, "ap.next"); 7745 Builder.CreateStore(NextPtr, VAListAddr); 7746 7747 return Builder.CreateBitCast(ArgAddr, ArgPtrTy, "arg.addr"); 7748 } 7749 7750 void SparcV9ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const { 7751 FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyType(FI.getReturnType(), 32 * 8); 7752 for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) 7753 I.info = classifyType(I.type, 16 * 8); 7754 } 7755 7756 namespace { 7757 class SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7758 public: 7759 SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7760 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SparcV9ABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7761 7762 int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override { 7763 return 14; 7764 } 7765 7766 bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 7767 llvm::Value *Address) const override; 7768 }; 7769 } // end anonymous namespace 7770 7771 bool 7772 SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, 7773 llvm::Value *Address) const { 7774 // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified 7775 // against gcc output. AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding. 7776 7777 CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 7778 7779 llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty; 7780 llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4); 7781 llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8); 7782 7783 // 0-31: the 8-byte general-purpose registers 7784 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 31); 7785 7786 // 32-63: f0-31, the 4-byte floating-point registers 7787 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 32, 63); 7788 7789 // Y = 64 7790 // PSR = 65 7791 // WIM = 66 7792 // TBR = 67 7793 // PC = 68 7794 // NPC = 69 7795 // FSR = 70 7796 // CSR = 71 7797 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 64, 71); 7798 7799 // 72-87: d0-15, the 8-byte floating-point registers 7800 AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 72, 87); 7801 7802 return false; 7803 } 7804 7805 7806 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7807 // XCore ABI Implementation 7808 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7809 7810 namespace { 7811 7812 /// A SmallStringEnc instance is used to build up the TypeString by passing 7813 /// it by reference between functions that append to it. 7814 typedef llvm::SmallString<128> SmallStringEnc; 7815 7816 /// TypeStringCache caches the meta encodings of Types. 7817 /// 7818 /// The reason for caching TypeStrings is two fold: 7819 /// 1. To cache a type's encoding for later uses; 7820 /// 2. As a means to break recursive member type inclusion. 7821 /// 7822 /// A cache Entry can have a Status of: 7823 /// NonRecursive: The type encoding is not recursive; 7824 /// Recursive: The type encoding is recursive; 7825 /// Incomplete: An incomplete TypeString; 7826 /// IncompleteUsed: An incomplete TypeString that has been used in a 7827 /// Recursive type encoding. 7828 /// 7829 /// A NonRecursive entry will have all of its sub-members expanded as fully 7830 /// as possible. Whilst it may contain types which are recursive, the type 7831 /// itself is not recursive and thus its encoding may be safely used whenever 7832 /// the type is encountered. 7833 /// 7834 /// A Recursive entry will have all of its sub-members expanded as fully as 7835 /// possible. The type itself is recursive and it may contain other types which 7836 /// are recursive. The Recursive encoding must not be used during the expansion 7837 /// of a recursive type's recursive branch. For simplicity the code uses 7838 /// IncompleteCount to reject all usage of Recursive encodings for member types. 7839 /// 7840 /// An Incomplete entry is always a RecordType and only encodes its 7841 /// identifier e.g. "s(S){}". Incomplete 'StubEnc' entries are ephemeral and 7842 /// are placed into the cache during type expansion as a means to identify and 7843 /// handle recursive inclusion of types as sub-members. If there is recursion 7844 /// the entry becomes IncompleteUsed. 7845 /// 7846 /// During the expansion of a RecordType's members: 7847 /// 7848 /// If the cache contains a NonRecursive encoding for the member type, the 7849 /// cached encoding is used; 7850 /// 7851 /// If the cache contains a Recursive encoding for the member type, the 7852 /// cached encoding is 'Swapped' out, as it may be incorrect, and... 7853 /// 7854 /// If the member is a RecordType, an Incomplete encoding is placed into the 7855 /// cache to break potential recursive inclusion of itself as a sub-member; 7856 /// 7857 /// Once a member RecordType has been expanded, its temporary incomplete 7858 /// entry is removed from the cache. If a Recursive encoding was swapped out 7859 /// it is swapped back in; 7860 /// 7861 /// If an incomplete entry is used to expand a sub-member, the incomplete 7862 /// entry is marked as IncompleteUsed. The cache keeps count of how many 7863 /// IncompleteUsed entries it currently contains in IncompleteUsedCount; 7864 /// 7865 /// If a member's encoding is found to be a NonRecursive or Recursive viz: 7866 /// IncompleteUsedCount==0, the member's encoding is added to the cache. 7867 /// Else the member is part of a recursive type and thus the recursion has 7868 /// been exited too soon for the encoding to be correct for the member. 7869 /// 7870 class TypeStringCache { 7871 enum Status {NonRecursive, Recursive, Incomplete, IncompleteUsed}; 7872 struct Entry { 7873 std::string Str; // The encoded TypeString for the type. 7874 enum Status State; // Information about the encoding in 'Str'. 7875 std::string Swapped; // A temporary place holder for a Recursive encoding 7876 // during the expansion of RecordType's members. 7877 }; 7878 std::map<const IdentifierInfo *, struct Entry> Map; 7879 unsigned IncompleteCount; // Number of Incomplete entries in the Map. 7880 unsigned IncompleteUsedCount; // Number of IncompleteUsed entries in the Map. 7881 public: 7882 TypeStringCache() : IncompleteCount(0), IncompleteUsedCount(0) {} 7883 void addIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, std::string StubEnc); 7884 bool removeIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID); 7885 void addIfComplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, StringRef Str, 7886 bool IsRecursive); 7887 StringRef lookupStr(const IdentifierInfo *ID); 7888 }; 7889 7890 /// TypeString encodings for enum & union fields must be order. 7891 /// FieldEncoding is a helper for this ordering process. 7892 class FieldEncoding { 7893 bool HasName; 7894 std::string Enc; 7895 public: 7896 FieldEncoding(bool b, SmallStringEnc &e) : HasName(b), Enc(e.c_str()) {} 7897 StringRef str() { return Enc; } 7898 bool operator<(const FieldEncoding &rhs) const { 7899 if (HasName != rhs.HasName) return HasName; 7900 return Enc < rhs.Enc; 7901 } 7902 }; 7903 7904 class XCoreABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo { 7905 public: 7906 XCoreABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {} 7907 Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7908 QualType Ty) const override; 7909 }; 7910 7911 class XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 7912 mutable TypeStringCache TSC; 7913 public: 7914 XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) 7915 :TargetCodeGenInfo(new XCoreABIInfo(CGT)) {} 7916 void emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 7917 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override; 7918 }; 7919 7920 } // End anonymous namespace. 7921 7922 // TODO: this implementation is likely now redundant with the default 7923 // EmitVAArg. 7924 Address XCoreABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, 7925 QualType Ty) const { 7926 CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder; 7927 7928 // Get the VAList. 7929 CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4); 7930 Address AP(Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize); 7931 7932 // Handle the argument. 7933 ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty); 7934 CharUnits TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty); 7935 llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty); 7936 if (AI.canHaveCoerceToType() && !AI.getCoerceToType()) 7937 AI.setCoerceToType(ArgTy); 7938 llvm::Type *ArgPtrTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(ArgTy); 7939 7940 Address Val = Address::invalid(); 7941 CharUnits ArgSize = CharUnits::Zero(); 7942 switch (AI.getKind()) { 7943 case ABIArgInfo::Expand: 7944 case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand: 7945 case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca: 7946 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI kind for va_arg"); 7947 case ABIArgInfo::Ignore: 7948 Val = Address(llvm::UndefValue::get(ArgPtrTy), TypeAlign); 7949 ArgSize = CharUnits::Zero(); 7950 break; 7951 case ABIArgInfo::Extend: 7952 case ABIArgInfo::Direct: 7953 Val = Builder.CreateBitCast(AP, ArgPtrTy); 7954 ArgSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity( 7955 getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AI.getCoerceToType())); 7956 ArgSize = ArgSize.alignTo(SlotSize); 7957 break; 7958 case ABIArgInfo::Indirect: 7959 Val = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(AP, ArgPtrTy); 7960 Val = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(Val), TypeAlign); 7961 ArgSize = SlotSize; 7962 break; 7963 } 7964 7965 // Increment the VAList. 7966 if (!ArgSize.isZero()) { 7967 llvm::Value *APN = 7968 Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(AP.getPointer(), ArgSize); 7969 Builder.CreateStore(APN, VAListAddr); 7970 } 7971 7972 return Val; 7973 } 7974 7975 /// During the expansion of a RecordType, an incomplete TypeString is placed 7976 /// into the cache as a means to identify and break recursion. 7977 /// If there is a Recursive encoding in the cache, it is swapped out and will 7978 /// be reinserted by removeIncomplete(). 7979 /// All other types of encoding should have been used rather than arriving here. 7980 void TypeStringCache::addIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, 7981 std::string StubEnc) { 7982 if (!ID) 7983 return; 7984 Entry &E = Map[ID]; 7985 assert( (E.Str.empty() || E.State == Recursive) && 7986 "Incorrectly use of addIncomplete"); 7987 assert(!StubEnc.empty() && "Passing an empty string to addIncomplete()"); 7988 E.Swapped.swap(E.Str); // swap out the Recursive 7989 E.Str.swap(StubEnc); 7990 E.State = Incomplete; 7991 ++IncompleteCount; 7992 } 7993 7994 /// Once the RecordType has been expanded, the temporary incomplete TypeString 7995 /// must be removed from the cache. 7996 /// If a Recursive was swapped out by addIncomplete(), it will be replaced. 7997 /// Returns true if the RecordType was defined recursively. 7998 bool TypeStringCache::removeIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 7999 if (!ID) 8000 return false; 8001 auto I = Map.find(ID); 8002 assert(I != Map.end() && "Entry not present"); 8003 Entry &E = I->second; 8004 assert( (E.State == Incomplete || 8005 E.State == IncompleteUsed) && 8006 "Entry must be an incomplete type"); 8007 bool IsRecursive = false; 8008 if (E.State == IncompleteUsed) { 8009 // We made use of our Incomplete encoding, thus we are recursive. 8010 IsRecursive = true; 8011 --IncompleteUsedCount; 8012 } 8013 if (E.Swapped.empty()) 8014 Map.erase(I); 8015 else { 8016 // Swap the Recursive back. 8017 E.Swapped.swap(E.Str); 8018 E.Swapped.clear(); 8019 E.State = Recursive; 8020 } 8021 --IncompleteCount; 8022 return IsRecursive; 8023 } 8024 8025 /// Add the encoded TypeString to the cache only if it is NonRecursive or 8026 /// Recursive (viz: all sub-members were expanded as fully as possible). 8027 void TypeStringCache::addIfComplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, StringRef Str, 8028 bool IsRecursive) { 8029 if (!ID || IncompleteUsedCount) 8030 return; // No key or it is is an incomplete sub-type so don't add. 8031 Entry &E = Map[ID]; 8032 if (IsRecursive && !E.Str.empty()) { 8033 assert(E.State==Recursive && E.Str.size() == Str.size() && 8034 "This is not the same Recursive entry"); 8035 // The parent container was not recursive after all, so we could have used 8036 // this Recursive sub-member entry after all, but we assumed the worse when 8037 // we started viz: IncompleteCount!=0. 8038 return; 8039 } 8040 assert(E.Str.empty() && "Entry already present"); 8041 E.Str = Str.str(); 8042 E.State = IsRecursive? Recursive : NonRecursive; 8043 } 8044 8045 /// Return a cached TypeString encoding for the ID. If there isn't one, or we 8046 /// are recursively expanding a type (IncompleteCount != 0) and the cached 8047 /// encoding is Recursive, return an empty StringRef. 8048 StringRef TypeStringCache::lookupStr(const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 8049 if (!ID) 8050 return StringRef(); // We have no key. 8051 auto I = Map.find(ID); 8052 if (I == Map.end()) 8053 return StringRef(); // We have no encoding. 8054 Entry &E = I->second; 8055 if (E.State == Recursive && IncompleteCount) 8056 return StringRef(); // We don't use Recursive encodings for member types. 8057 8058 if (E.State == Incomplete) { 8059 // The incomplete type is being used to break out of recursion. 8060 E.State = IncompleteUsed; 8061 ++IncompleteUsedCount; 8062 } 8063 return E.Str; 8064 } 8065 8066 /// The XCore ABI includes a type information section that communicates symbol 8067 /// type information to the linker. The linker uses this information to verify 8068 /// safety/correctness of things such as array bound and pointers et al. 8069 /// The ABI only requires C (and XC) language modules to emit TypeStrings. 8070 /// This type information (TypeString) is emitted into meta data for all global 8071 /// symbols: definitions, declarations, functions & variables. 8072 /// 8073 /// The TypeString carries type, qualifier, name, size & value details. 8074 /// Please see 'Tools Development Guide' section 2.16.2 for format details: 8075 /// https://www.xmos.com/download/public/Tools-Development-Guide%28X9114A%29.pdf 8076 /// The output is tested by test/CodeGen/xcore-stringtype.c. 8077 /// 8078 static bool getTypeString(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const Decl *D, 8079 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, TypeStringCache &TSC); 8080 8081 /// XCore uses emitTargetMD to emit TypeString metadata for global symbols. 8082 void XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo::emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, 8083 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const { 8084 SmallStringEnc Enc; 8085 if (getTypeString(Enc, D, CGM, TSC)) { 8086 llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = CGM.getModule().getContext(); 8087 llvm::Metadata *MDVals[] = {llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(GV), 8088 llvm::MDString::get(Ctx, Enc.str())}; 8089 llvm::NamedMDNode *MD = 8090 CGM.getModule().getOrInsertNamedMetadata("xcore.typestrings"); 8091 MD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, MDVals)); 8092 } 8093 } 8094 8095 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8096 // SPIR ABI Implementation 8097 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8098 8099 namespace { 8100 class SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo { 8101 public: 8102 SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) 8103 : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {} 8104 unsigned getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const override; 8105 }; 8106 8107 } // End anonymous namespace. 8108 8109 namespace clang { 8110 namespace CodeGen { 8111 void computeSPIRKernelABIInfo(CodeGenModule &CGM, CGFunctionInfo &FI) { 8112 DefaultABIInfo SPIRABI(CGM.getTypes()); 8113 SPIRABI.computeInfo(FI); 8114 } 8115 } 8116 } 8117 8118 unsigned SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const { 8119 return llvm::CallingConv::SPIR_KERNEL; 8120 } 8121 8122 static bool appendType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QType, 8123 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8124 TypeStringCache &TSC); 8125 8126 /// Helper function for appendRecordType(). 8127 /// Builds a SmallVector containing the encoded field types in declaration 8128 /// order. 8129 static bool extractFieldType(SmallVectorImpl<FieldEncoding> &FE, 8130 const RecordDecl *RD, 8131 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8132 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 8133 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) { 8134 SmallStringEnc Enc; 8135 Enc += "m("; 8136 Enc += Field->getName(); 8137 Enc += "){"; 8138 if (Field->isBitField()) { 8139 Enc += "b("; 8140 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Enc); 8141 OS << Field->getBitWidthValue(CGM.getContext()); 8142 Enc += ':'; 8143 } 8144 if (!appendType(Enc, Field->getType(), CGM, TSC)) 8145 return false; 8146 if (Field->isBitField()) 8147 Enc += ')'; 8148 Enc += '}'; 8149 FE.emplace_back(!Field->getName().empty(), Enc); 8150 } 8151 return true; 8152 } 8153 8154 /// Appends structure and union types to Enc and adds encoding to cache. 8155 /// Recursively calls appendType (via extractFieldType) for each field. 8156 /// Union types have their fields ordered according to the ABI. 8157 static bool appendRecordType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const RecordType *RT, 8158 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8159 TypeStringCache &TSC, const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 8160 // Append the cached TypeString if we have one. 8161 StringRef TypeString = TSC.lookupStr(ID); 8162 if (!TypeString.empty()) { 8163 Enc += TypeString; 8164 return true; 8165 } 8166 8167 // Start to emit an incomplete TypeString. 8168 size_t Start = Enc.size(); 8169 Enc += (RT->isUnionType()? 'u' : 's'); 8170 Enc += '('; 8171 if (ID) 8172 Enc += ID->getName(); 8173 Enc += "){"; 8174 8175 // We collect all encoded fields and order as necessary. 8176 bool IsRecursive = false; 8177 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl()->getDefinition(); 8178 if (RD && !RD->field_empty()) { 8179 // An incomplete TypeString stub is placed in the cache for this RecordType 8180 // so that recursive calls to this RecordType will use it whilst building a 8181 // complete TypeString for this RecordType. 8182 SmallVector<FieldEncoding, 16> FE; 8183 std::string StubEnc(Enc.substr(Start).str()); 8184 StubEnc += '}'; // StubEnc now holds a valid incomplete TypeString. 8185 TSC.addIncomplete(ID, std::move(StubEnc)); 8186 if (!extractFieldType(FE, RD, CGM, TSC)) { 8187 (void) TSC.removeIncomplete(ID); 8188 return false; 8189 } 8190 IsRecursive = TSC.removeIncomplete(ID); 8191 // The ABI requires unions to be sorted but not structures. 8192 // See FieldEncoding::operator< for sort algorithm. 8193 if (RT->isUnionType()) 8194 std::sort(FE.begin(), FE.end()); 8195 // We can now complete the TypeString. 8196 unsigned E = FE.size(); 8197 for (unsigned I = 0; I != E; ++I) { 8198 if (I) 8199 Enc += ','; 8200 Enc += FE[I].str(); 8201 } 8202 } 8203 Enc += '}'; 8204 TSC.addIfComplete(ID, Enc.substr(Start), IsRecursive); 8205 return true; 8206 } 8207 8208 /// Appends enum types to Enc and adds the encoding to the cache. 8209 static bool appendEnumType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const EnumType *ET, 8210 TypeStringCache &TSC, 8211 const IdentifierInfo *ID) { 8212 // Append the cached TypeString if we have one. 8213 StringRef TypeString = TSC.lookupStr(ID); 8214 if (!TypeString.empty()) { 8215 Enc += TypeString; 8216 return true; 8217 } 8218 8219 size_t Start = Enc.size(); 8220 Enc += "e("; 8221 if (ID) 8222 Enc += ID->getName(); 8223 Enc += "){"; 8224 8225 // We collect all encoded enumerations and order them alphanumerically. 8226 if (const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl()->getDefinition()) { 8227 SmallVector<FieldEncoding, 16> FE; 8228 for (auto I = ED->enumerator_begin(), E = ED->enumerator_end(); I != E; 8229 ++I) { 8230 SmallStringEnc EnumEnc; 8231 EnumEnc += "m("; 8232 EnumEnc += I->getName(); 8233 EnumEnc += "){"; 8234 I->getInitVal().toString(EnumEnc); 8235 EnumEnc += '}'; 8236 FE.push_back(FieldEncoding(!I->getName().empty(), EnumEnc)); 8237 } 8238 std::sort(FE.begin(), FE.end()); 8239 unsigned E = FE.size(); 8240 for (unsigned I = 0; I != E; ++I) { 8241 if (I) 8242 Enc += ','; 8243 Enc += FE[I].str(); 8244 } 8245 } 8246 Enc += '}'; 8247 TSC.addIfComplete(ID, Enc.substr(Start), false); 8248 return true; 8249 } 8250 8251 /// Appends type's qualifier to Enc. 8252 /// This is done prior to appending the type's encoding. 8253 static void appendQualifier(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QT) { 8254 // Qualifiers are emitted in alphabetical order. 8255 static const char *const Table[]={"","c:","r:","cr:","v:","cv:","rv:","crv:"}; 8256 int Lookup = 0; 8257 if (QT.isConstQualified()) 8258 Lookup += 1<<0; 8259 if (QT.isRestrictQualified()) 8260 Lookup += 1<<1; 8261 if (QT.isVolatileQualified()) 8262 Lookup += 1<<2; 8263 Enc += Table[Lookup]; 8264 } 8265 8266 /// Appends built-in types to Enc. 8267 static bool appendBuiltinType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const BuiltinType *BT) { 8268 const char *EncType; 8269 switch (BT->getKind()) { 8270 case BuiltinType::Void: 8271 EncType = "0"; 8272 break; 8273 case BuiltinType::Bool: 8274 EncType = "b"; 8275 break; 8276 case BuiltinType::Char_U: 8277 EncType = "uc"; 8278 break; 8279 case BuiltinType::UChar: 8280 EncType = "uc"; 8281 break; 8282 case BuiltinType::SChar: 8283 EncType = "sc"; 8284 break; 8285 case BuiltinType::UShort: 8286 EncType = "us"; 8287 break; 8288 case BuiltinType::Short: 8289 EncType = "ss"; 8290 break; 8291 case BuiltinType::UInt: 8292 EncType = "ui"; 8293 break; 8294 case BuiltinType::Int: 8295 EncType = "si"; 8296 break; 8297 case BuiltinType::ULong: 8298 EncType = "ul"; 8299 break; 8300 case BuiltinType::Long: 8301 EncType = "sl"; 8302 break; 8303 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: 8304 EncType = "ull"; 8305 break; 8306 case BuiltinType::LongLong: 8307 EncType = "sll"; 8308 break; 8309 case BuiltinType::Float: 8310 EncType = "ft"; 8311 break; 8312 case BuiltinType::Double: 8313 EncType = "d"; 8314 break; 8315 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: 8316 EncType = "ld"; 8317 break; 8318 default: 8319 return false; 8320 } 8321 Enc += EncType; 8322 return true; 8323 } 8324 8325 /// Appends a pointer encoding to Enc before calling appendType for the pointee. 8326 static bool appendPointerType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const PointerType *PT, 8327 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8328 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 8329 Enc += "p("; 8330 if (!appendType(Enc, PT->getPointeeType(), CGM, TSC)) 8331 return false; 8332 Enc += ')'; 8333 return true; 8334 } 8335 8336 /// Appends array encoding to Enc before calling appendType for the element. 8337 static bool appendArrayType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QT, 8338 const ArrayType *AT, 8339 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8340 TypeStringCache &TSC, StringRef NoSizeEnc) { 8341 if (AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Normal) 8342 return false; 8343 Enc += "a("; 8344 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) 8345 CAT->getSize().toStringUnsigned(Enc); 8346 else 8347 Enc += NoSizeEnc; // Global arrays use "*", otherwise it is "". 8348 Enc += ':'; 8349 // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array. 8350 appendQualifier(Enc, QT); 8351 if (!appendType(Enc, AT->getElementType(), CGM, TSC)) 8352 return false; 8353 Enc += ')'; 8354 return true; 8355 } 8356 8357 /// Appends a function encoding to Enc, calling appendType for the return type 8358 /// and the arguments. 8359 static bool appendFunctionType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const FunctionType *FT, 8360 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8361 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 8362 Enc += "f{"; 8363 if (!appendType(Enc, FT->getReturnType(), CGM, TSC)) 8364 return false; 8365 Enc += "}("; 8366 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FT->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 8367 // N.B. we are only interested in the adjusted param types. 8368 auto I = FPT->param_type_begin(); 8369 auto E = FPT->param_type_end(); 8370 if (I != E) { 8371 do { 8372 if (!appendType(Enc, *I, CGM, TSC)) 8373 return false; 8374 ++I; 8375 if (I != E) 8376 Enc += ','; 8377 } while (I != E); 8378 if (FPT->isVariadic()) 8379 Enc += ",va"; 8380 } else { 8381 if (FPT->isVariadic()) 8382 Enc += "va"; 8383 else 8384 Enc += '0'; 8385 } 8386 } 8387 Enc += ')'; 8388 return true; 8389 } 8390 8391 /// Handles the type's qualifier before dispatching a call to handle specific 8392 /// type encodings. 8393 static bool appendType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QType, 8394 const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, 8395 TypeStringCache &TSC) { 8396 8397 QualType QT = QType.getCanonicalType(); 8398 8399 if (const ArrayType *AT = QT->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()) 8400 // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array. 8401 // Thus we don't call appendQualifier() here. 8402 return appendArrayType(Enc, QT, AT, CGM, TSC, ""); 8403 8404 appendQualifier(Enc, QT); 8405 8406 if (const BuiltinType *BT = QT->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 8407 return appendBuiltinType(Enc, BT); 8408 8409 if (const PointerType *PT = QT->getAs<PointerType>()) 8410 return appendPointerType(Enc, PT, CGM, TSC); 8411 8412 if (const EnumType *ET = QT->getAs<EnumType>()) 8413 return appendEnumType(Enc, ET, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier()); 8414 8415 if (const RecordType *RT = QT->getAsStructureType()) 8416 return appendRecordType(Enc, RT, CGM, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier()); 8417 8418 if (const RecordType *RT = QT->getAsUnionType()) 8419 return appendRecordType(Enc, RT, CGM, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier()); 8420 8421 if (const FunctionType *FT = QT->getAs<FunctionType>()) 8422 return appendFunctionType(Enc, FT, CGM, TSC); 8423 8424 return false; 8425 } 8426 8427 static bool getTypeString(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const Decl *D, 8428 CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, TypeStringCache &TSC) { 8429 if (!D) 8430 return false; 8431 8432 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 8433 if (FD->getLanguageLinkage() != CLanguageLinkage) 8434 return false; 8435 return appendType(Enc, FD->getType(), CGM, TSC); 8436 } 8437 8438 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 8439 if (VD->getLanguageLinkage() != CLanguageLinkage) 8440 return false; 8441 QualType QT = VD->getType().getCanonicalType(); 8442 if (const ArrayType *AT = QT->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()) { 8443 // Global ArrayTypes are given a size of '*' if the size is unknown. 8444 // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array. 8445 // Thus we don't call appendQualifier() here. 8446 return appendArrayType(Enc, QT, AT, CGM, TSC, "*"); 8447 } 8448 return appendType(Enc, QT, CGM, TSC); 8449 } 8450 return false; 8451 } 8452 8453 8454 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8455 // Driver code 8456 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8457 8458 bool CodeGenModule::supportsCOMDAT() const { 8459 return getTriple().supportsCOMDAT(); 8460 } 8461 8462 const TargetCodeGenInfo &CodeGenModule::getTargetCodeGenInfo() { 8463 if (TheTargetCodeGenInfo) 8464 return *TheTargetCodeGenInfo; 8465 8466 // Helper to set the unique_ptr while still keeping the return value. 8467 auto SetCGInfo = [&](TargetCodeGenInfo *P) -> const TargetCodeGenInfo & { 8468 this->TheTargetCodeGenInfo.reset(P); 8469 return *P; 8470 }; 8471 8472 const llvm::Triple &Triple = getTarget().getTriple(); 8473 switch (Triple.getArch()) { 8474 default: 8475 return SetCGInfo(new DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8476 8477 case llvm::Triple::le32: 8478 return SetCGInfo(new PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8479 case llvm::Triple::mips: 8480 case llvm::Triple::mipsel: 8481 if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::NaCl) 8482 return SetCGInfo(new PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8483 return SetCGInfo(new MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, true)); 8484 8485 case llvm::Triple::mips64: 8486 case llvm::Triple::mips64el: 8487 return SetCGInfo(new MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, false)); 8488 8489 case llvm::Triple::avr: 8490 return SetCGInfo(new AVRTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8491 8492 case llvm::Triple::aarch64: 8493 case llvm::Triple::aarch64_be: { 8494 AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = AArch64ABIInfo::AAPCS; 8495 if (getTarget().getABI() == "darwinpcs") 8496 Kind = AArch64ABIInfo::DarwinPCS; 8497 8498 return SetCGInfo(new AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind)); 8499 } 8500 8501 case llvm::Triple::wasm32: 8502 case llvm::Triple::wasm64: 8503 return SetCGInfo(new WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8504 8505 case llvm::Triple::arm: 8506 case llvm::Triple::armeb: 8507 case llvm::Triple::thumb: 8508 case llvm::Triple::thumbeb: { 8509 if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::Win32) { 8510 return SetCGInfo( 8511 new WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP)); 8512 } 8513 8514 ARMABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS; 8515 StringRef ABIStr = getTarget().getABI(); 8516 if (ABIStr == "apcs-gnu") 8517 Kind = ARMABIInfo::APCS; 8518 else if (ABIStr == "aapcs16") 8519 Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP; 8520 else if (CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "hard" || 8521 (CodeGenOpts.FloatABI != "soft" && 8522 (Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF || 8523 Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF || 8524 Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::EABIHF))) 8525 Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP; 8526 8527 return SetCGInfo(new ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind)); 8528 } 8529 8530 case llvm::Triple::ppc: 8531 return SetCGInfo( 8532 new PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft")); 8533 case llvm::Triple::ppc64: 8534 if (Triple.isOSBinFormatELF()) { 8535 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv1; 8536 if (getTarget().getABI() == "elfv2") 8537 Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv2; 8538 bool HasQPX = getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx"; 8539 bool IsSoftFloat = CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft"; 8540 8541 return SetCGInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind, HasQPX, 8542 IsSoftFloat)); 8543 } else 8544 return SetCGInfo(new PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8545 case llvm::Triple::ppc64le: { 8546 assert(Triple.isOSBinFormatELF() && "PPC64 LE non-ELF not supported!"); 8547 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv2; 8548 if (getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1" || getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx") 8549 Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv1; 8550 bool HasQPX = getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx"; 8551 bool IsSoftFloat = CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft"; 8552 8553 return SetCGInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind, HasQPX, 8554 IsSoftFloat)); 8555 } 8556 8557 case llvm::Triple::nvptx: 8558 case llvm::Triple::nvptx64: 8559 return SetCGInfo(new NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8560 8561 case llvm::Triple::msp430: 8562 return SetCGInfo(new MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8563 8564 case llvm::Triple::systemz: { 8565 bool HasVector = getTarget().getABI() == "vector"; 8566 return SetCGInfo(new SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, HasVector)); 8567 } 8568 8569 case llvm::Triple::tce: 8570 case llvm::Triple::tcele: 8571 return SetCGInfo(new TCETargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8572 8573 case llvm::Triple::x86: { 8574 bool IsDarwinVectorABI = Triple.isOSDarwin(); 8575 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI = 8576 X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI(Triple, CodeGenOpts); 8577 bool IsWin32FloatStructABI = Triple.isOSWindows() && !Triple.isOSCygMing(); 8578 8579 if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::Win32) { 8580 return SetCGInfo(new WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo( 8581 Types, IsDarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, 8582 IsWin32FloatStructABI, CodeGenOpts.NumRegisterParameters)); 8583 } else { 8584 return SetCGInfo(new X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo( 8585 Types, IsDarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, 8586 IsWin32FloatStructABI, CodeGenOpts.NumRegisterParameters, 8587 CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft")); 8588 } 8589 } 8590 8591 case llvm::Triple::x86_64: { 8592 StringRef ABI = getTarget().getABI(); 8593 X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel = 8594 (ABI == "avx512" 8595 ? X86AVXABILevel::AVX512 8596 : ABI == "avx" ? X86AVXABILevel::AVX : X86AVXABILevel::None); 8597 8598 switch (Triple.getOS()) { 8599 case llvm::Triple::Win32: 8600 return SetCGInfo(new WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel)); 8601 case llvm::Triple::PS4: 8602 return SetCGInfo(new PS4TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel)); 8603 default: 8604 return SetCGInfo(new X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel)); 8605 } 8606 } 8607 case llvm::Triple::hexagon: 8608 return SetCGInfo(new HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8609 case llvm::Triple::lanai: 8610 return SetCGInfo(new LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8611 case llvm::Triple::r600: 8612 return SetCGInfo(new AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8613 case llvm::Triple::amdgcn: 8614 return SetCGInfo(new AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8615 case llvm::Triple::sparc: 8616 return SetCGInfo(new SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8617 case llvm::Triple::sparcv9: 8618 return SetCGInfo(new SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8619 case llvm::Triple::xcore: 8620 return SetCGInfo(new XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8621 case llvm::Triple::spir: 8622 case llvm::Triple::spir64: 8623 return SetCGInfo(new SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo(Types)); 8624 } 8625 } 8626